1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */ 2 /* 3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface 4 * 5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc. 6 * Copyright 2006-2007 Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz> 7 * Copyright 2007-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> 8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH 9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH 10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2023 Intel Corporation 11 */ 12 13 #ifndef MAC80211_H 14 #define MAC80211_H 15 16 #include <linux/bug.h> 17 #include <linux/kernel.h> 18 #include <linux/if_ether.h> 19 #include <linux/skbuff.h> 20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h> 21 #include <linux/lockdep.h> 22 #include <net/cfg80211.h> 23 #include <net/codel.h> 24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h> 25 #include <asm/unaligned.h> 26 27 /** 28 * DOC: Introduction 29 * 30 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements 31 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document 32 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware 33 * drivers. 34 */ 35 36 /** 37 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts 38 * 39 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be 40 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any 41 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such 42 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the 43 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even 44 * tasklet function. 45 * 46 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also 47 * use the non-IRQ-safe functions! 48 */ 49 50 /** 51 * DOC: Warning 52 * 53 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will 54 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet. 55 */ 56 57 /** 58 * DOC: Frame format 59 * 60 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver, 61 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are 62 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the 63 * hardware. 64 * 65 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features: 66 * 67 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload 68 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware. 69 * 70 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to 71 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU. 72 */ 73 74 /** 75 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue 76 * 77 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use. 78 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by 79 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the 80 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback. 81 * 82 * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during 83 * suspend. 84 * 85 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock. 86 * 87 */ 88 89 /** 90 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing 91 * 92 * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the 93 * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between 94 * different stations/interfaces. 95 * 96 * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either 97 * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom 98 * handler. 99 * 100 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with 101 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and 102 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames. 103 * 104 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations 105 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops. 106 * 107 * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly. 108 * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue 109 * driver op. 110 * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling 111 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will 112 * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation. 113 * 114 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to 115 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to 116 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls 117 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using 118 * ieee80211_return_txq(). 119 * 120 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has 121 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling 122 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq 123 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls 124 * .release_buffered_frames(). 125 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own 126 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained 127 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue). 128 */ 129 130 /** 131 * DOC: HW timestamping 132 * 133 * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps 134 * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks. 135 * 136 * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing 137 * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp 138 * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the 139 * ieee80211_rx_status struct. 140 * 141 * Similarly, To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine 142 * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field 143 * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the 144 * ieee80211_tx_status struct. 145 */ 146 struct device; 147 148 /** 149 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues 150 * 151 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues. 152 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set 153 */ 154 enum ieee80211_max_queues { 155 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES = 16, 156 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP = BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1, 157 }; 158 159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 0xff 160 161 /** 162 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211 163 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice 164 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video 165 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort 166 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background 167 */ 168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers { 169 IEEE80211_AC_VO = 0, 170 IEEE80211_AC_VI = 1, 171 IEEE80211_AC_BE = 2, 172 IEEE80211_AC_BK = 3, 173 }; 174 175 /** 176 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration 177 * 178 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS 179 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29. 180 * 181 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255] 182 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form 183 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767] 184 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min] 185 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled 186 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category 187 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue 188 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured 189 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE 190 */ 191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params { 192 u16 txop; 193 u16 cw_min; 194 u16 cw_max; 195 u8 aifs; 196 bool acm; 197 bool uapsd; 198 bool mu_edca; 199 struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec; 200 }; 201 202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats { 203 unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount; 204 unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount; 205 unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount; 206 unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount; 207 }; 208 209 /** 210 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context 211 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed 212 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed 213 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed 214 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel, 215 * this is used only with channel switching with CSA 216 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed 217 */ 218 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change { 219 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH = BIT(0), 220 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS = BIT(1), 221 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR = BIT(2), 222 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(3), 223 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH = BIT(4), 224 }; 225 226 /** 227 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to 228 * 229 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx 230 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only. 231 * 232 * @def: the channel definition 233 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required. 234 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be 235 * active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions 236 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled 237 * after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions; 238 * this will always be >= @rx_chains_static. 239 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel. 240 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to 241 * sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information. 242 */ 243 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf { 244 struct cfg80211_chan_def def; 245 struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def; 246 247 u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic; 248 249 bool radar_enabled; 250 251 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 252 }; 253 254 /** 255 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode 256 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already 257 * exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface 258 * needs to be switched from one to the other. 259 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop 260 * to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but 261 * will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches 262 * from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course 263 * implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing 264 * hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context 265 * will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used 266 * for changes/removal.) 267 */ 268 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode { 269 CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF, 270 CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS, 271 }; 272 273 /** 274 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information 275 * 276 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that 277 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another. The 278 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be 279 * done. 280 * 281 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx 282 * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching 283 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned 284 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned 285 */ 286 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch { 287 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 288 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf; 289 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx; 290 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx; 291 }; 292 293 /** 294 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags 295 * 296 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed() 297 * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed. 298 * 299 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated), 300 * also implies a change in the AID. 301 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed 302 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed 303 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed 304 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed 305 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed 306 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed 307 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever 308 * reason (IBSS and managed mode) 309 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve 310 * new beacon (beaconing modes) 311 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be 312 * enabled/disabled (beaconing modes) 313 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed 314 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed 315 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed. 316 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note 317 * that it is only ever disabled for station mode. 318 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface. 319 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode) 320 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode) 321 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode) 322 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface 323 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS) 324 * changed 325 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available: 326 * currently dtim_period only is under consideration. 327 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed, 328 * note that this is only called when it changes after the channel 329 * context had been assigned. 330 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed 331 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed 332 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected 333 * keep alive) changed. 334 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface 335 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder 336 * functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode). 337 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed 338 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed. 339 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed 340 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed. 341 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response 342 * status changed. 343 * @BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING: The channel puncturing bitmap changed. 344 */ 345 enum ieee80211_bss_change { 346 BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC = 1<<0, 347 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT = 1<<1, 348 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE = 1<<2, 349 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT = 1<<3, 350 BSS_CHANGED_HT = 1<<4, 351 BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES = 1<<5, 352 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT = 1<<6, 353 BSS_CHANGED_BSSID = 1<<7, 354 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON = 1<<8, 355 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED = 1<<9, 356 BSS_CHANGED_CQM = 1<<10, 357 BSS_CHANGED_IBSS = 1<<11, 358 BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER = 1<<12, 359 BSS_CHANGED_QOS = 1<<13, 360 BSS_CHANGED_IDLE = 1<<14, 361 BSS_CHANGED_SSID = 1<<15, 362 BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP = 1<<16, 363 BSS_CHANGED_PS = 1<<17, 364 BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER = 1<<18, 365 BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS = 1<<19, 366 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO = 1<<20, 367 BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH = 1<<21, 368 BSS_CHANGED_OCB = 1<<22, 369 BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS = 1<<23, 370 BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE = 1<<24, 371 BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE = 1<<25, 372 BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER = 1<<26, 373 BSS_CHANGED_TWT = 1<<27, 374 BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD = 1<<28, 375 BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR = 1<<29, 376 BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY = 1<<30, 377 BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31, 378 BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING = BIT_ULL(32), 379 380 /* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */ 381 }; 382 383 /* 384 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number 385 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP 386 * filtering will be disabled. 387 */ 388 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4 389 390 /** 391 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver 392 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver. 393 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME 394 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received 395 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because 396 * they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only 397 * once each time the timeout triggers. 398 */ 399 enum ieee80211_event_type { 400 RSSI_EVENT, 401 MLME_EVENT, 402 BAR_RX_EVENT, 403 BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT, 404 }; 405 406 /** 407 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT 408 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver. 409 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver. 410 */ 411 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data { 412 RSSI_EVENT_HIGH, 413 RSSI_EVENT_LOW, 414 }; 415 416 /** 417 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT 418 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data 419 */ 420 struct ieee80211_rssi_event { 421 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data; 422 }; 423 424 /** 425 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT 426 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication 427 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association 428 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received.. 429 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent. 430 */ 431 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data { 432 AUTH_EVENT, 433 ASSOC_EVENT, 434 DEAUTH_RX_EVENT, 435 DEAUTH_TX_EVENT, 436 }; 437 438 /** 439 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT 440 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully. 441 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer. 442 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out. 443 */ 444 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status { 445 MLME_SUCCESS, 446 MLME_DENIED, 447 MLME_TIMEOUT, 448 }; 449 450 /** 451 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT 452 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data 453 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status 454 * @reason: the reason code if applicable 455 */ 456 struct ieee80211_mlme_event { 457 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data; 458 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status; 459 u16 reason; 460 }; 461 462 /** 463 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events 464 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates 465 * @tid: the tid 466 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT) 467 */ 468 struct ieee80211_ba_event { 469 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 470 u16 tid; 471 u16 ssn; 472 }; 473 474 /** 475 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver 476 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type. 477 * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT 478 * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT 479 * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT 480 * @u:union holding the fields above 481 */ 482 struct ieee80211_event { 483 enum ieee80211_event_type type; 484 union { 485 struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi; 486 struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme; 487 struct ieee80211_ba_event ba; 488 } u; 489 }; 490 491 /** 492 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data 493 * 494 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO 495 * 496 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group 497 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group 498 */ 499 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data { 500 u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN]; 501 u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN]; 502 }; 503 504 /** 505 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters 506 * 507 * @lci: LCI subelement content 508 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content 509 * @lci_len: LCI data length 510 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length 511 */ 512 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params { 513 const u8 *lci; 514 const u8 *civicloc; 515 size_t lci_len; 516 size_t civicloc_len; 517 }; 518 519 /** 520 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from 521 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail. 522 * 523 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 524 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 525 */ 526 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery { 527 u32 min_interval; 528 u32 max_interval; 529 }; 530 531 /** 532 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters 533 * 534 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association 535 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS. 536 * 537 * @vif: reference to owning VIF 538 * @addr: (link) address used locally 539 * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO 540 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE 541 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP 542 * @ack_enabled: indicates support to receive a multi-TID that solicits either 543 * ACK, BACK or both 544 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field 545 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us 546 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE 547 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed 548 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role) 549 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed 550 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role) 551 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames 552 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT 553 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection 554 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble 555 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP) 556 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing, 557 * valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified 558 * with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then. 559 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old 560 * as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the 561 * HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can 562 * only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after 563 * association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the 564 * %BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice. 565 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf, 566 * the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation 567 * (see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice. 568 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY 569 * is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts. 570 * IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync 571 * by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently 572 * guaranteed only in certain callbacks. 573 * Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't 574 * know how to track beacons for all of the links for this. 575 * @beacon_int: beacon interval 576 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp 577 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an 578 * index into the rate table configured by the driver in 579 * the current band. 580 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate 581 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled) 582 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS 583 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not 584 * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be 585 * configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example. 586 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data 587 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation. 588 * This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel. 589 * Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must 590 * be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT. 591 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value 592 * implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should 593 * cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in 594 * relation to the newly configured threshold. 595 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value 596 * implies disabled. This is an alternative mechanism to the single 597 * threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it. 598 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold. 599 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis 600 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS. 601 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode. 602 * @txpower: TX power in dBm. INT_MIN means not configured. 603 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit 604 * Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular 605 * TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is 606 * NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from 607 * userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to 608 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace) 609 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave 610 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed 611 * to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS 612 * if it has associated clients without P2P PS support. 613 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from 614 * transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated. 615 * In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include 616 * a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element. 617 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN 618 * protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the 619 * station. 620 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM 621 * responder functionality. 622 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder. 623 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile 624 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP 625 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set 626 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set 627 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of 628 * nontransmitted BSSIDs 629 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received 630 * in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set. 631 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are 632 * connected to (STA) 633 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters. 634 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE 635 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration 636 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response 637 * interval. 638 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed 639 * to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware. 640 * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz 641 * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS. 642 * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env. 643 * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS. 644 * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT 645 * @eht_puncturing: bitmap to indicate which channels are punctured in this BSS 646 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is 647 * write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine 648 * for read access. 649 * @csa_punct_bitmap: new puncturing bitmap for channel switch 650 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability 651 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL 652 * when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX 653 * path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always 654 * be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be 655 * processed after it switches back to %NULL. 656 * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing. Internally it is 657 * write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine 658 * for read access. 659 * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change. 660 * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability. 661 * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability. 662 * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability. 663 * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU 664 * beamformer 665 * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU 666 * beamformee 667 * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU 668 * beamformer 669 * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU 670 * beamformee 671 * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU 672 * beamformer 673 * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU 674 * beamformee 675 * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU 676 * beamformer 677 * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission 678 * (non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU 679 * bandwidth 680 * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU 681 * beamformer 682 * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU 683 * beamformee 684 * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU 685 * beamformer 686 */ 687 struct ieee80211_bss_conf { 688 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 689 690 const u8 *bssid; 691 unsigned int link_id; 692 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 693 u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext; 694 bool uora_exists; 695 u8 uora_ocw_range; 696 u16 frame_time_rts_th; 697 bool he_support; 698 bool twt_requester; 699 bool twt_responder; 700 bool twt_protected; 701 bool twt_broadcast; 702 /* erp related data */ 703 bool use_cts_prot; 704 bool use_short_preamble; 705 bool use_short_slot; 706 bool enable_beacon; 707 u8 dtim_period; 708 u16 beacon_int; 709 u16 assoc_capability; 710 u64 sync_tsf; 711 u32 sync_device_ts; 712 u8 sync_dtim_count; 713 u32 basic_rates; 714 struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate; 715 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 716 u16 ht_operation_mode; 717 s32 cqm_rssi_thold; 718 u32 cqm_rssi_hyst; 719 s32 cqm_rssi_low; 720 s32 cqm_rssi_high; 721 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 722 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group; 723 bool qos; 724 bool hidden_ssid; 725 int txpower; 726 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type; 727 struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr; 728 bool allow_p2p_go_ps; 729 u16 max_idle_period; 730 bool protected_keep_alive; 731 bool ftm_responder; 732 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params; 733 /* Multiple BSSID data */ 734 bool nontransmitted; 735 u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 736 u8 bssid_index; 737 u8 bssid_indicator; 738 bool ema_ap; 739 u8 profile_periodicity; 740 struct { 741 u32 params; 742 u16 nss_set; 743 } he_oper; 744 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd; 745 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color; 746 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery; 747 u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval; 748 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate; 749 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type; 750 struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT]; 751 u8 tx_pwr_env_num; 752 u8 pwr_reduction; 753 bool eht_support; 754 u16 eht_puncturing; 755 756 bool csa_active; 757 u16 csa_punct_bitmap; 758 759 bool mu_mimo_owner; 760 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf; 761 762 bool color_change_active; 763 u8 color_change_color; 764 765 bool ht_ldpc; 766 bool vht_ldpc; 767 bool he_ldpc; 768 bool vht_su_beamformer; 769 bool vht_su_beamformee; 770 bool vht_mu_beamformer; 771 bool vht_mu_beamformee; 772 bool he_su_beamformer; 773 bool he_su_beamformee; 774 bool he_mu_beamformer; 775 bool he_full_ul_mumimo; 776 bool eht_su_beamformer; 777 bool eht_su_beamformee; 778 bool eht_mu_beamformer; 779 }; 780 781 /** 782 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status 783 * 784 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info. 785 * 786 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame. 787 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence 788 * number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment 789 * number and increasing the sequence number only when the 790 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly 791 * assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly 792 * for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from 793 * that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing. 794 * If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to 795 * assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE 796 * 802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for 797 * beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field. 798 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack 799 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination 800 * station 801 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame 802 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon 803 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU 804 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211. 805 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted 806 * because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to 807 * avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or 808 * firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station 809 * went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on 810 * the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for 811 * that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above), 812 * since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the 813 * hardware queue. 814 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged 815 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status 816 * is for the whole aggregation. 817 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned, 818 * so consider using block ack request (BAR). 819 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be 820 * set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will 821 * be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment) 822 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate 823 * that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for 824 * off-channel operation. 825 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation 826 * (header conversion) 827 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211, 828 * used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS 829 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211, 830 * used to indicate frame should not be encrypted 831 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll 832 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must 833 * be sent although the station is in powersave mode. 834 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the 835 * transmit function after the current frame, this can be used 836 * by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the 837 * queue gets full. 838 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted 839 * after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not 840 * be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.) 841 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME 842 * code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status 843 * should kick the MLME state machine. 844 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211 845 * MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX 846 * status to user space) 847 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame 848 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this 849 * frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use. 850 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on 851 * the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done 852 * in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be 853 * handled properly by the device. 854 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP 855 * testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow 856 * TKIP countermeasures to be tested. 857 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate. 858 * This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P 859 * frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band. 860 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period, 861 * when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in 862 * an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames 863 * the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for 864 * PS-Poll responses. 865 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate. 866 * This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when 867 * the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose. 868 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it 869 * would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for 870 * monitor injection). 871 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with 872 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without 873 * any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW). 874 * This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack 875 * behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK. 876 * 877 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't 878 * forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary. 879 */ 880 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags { 881 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS = BIT(0), 882 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ = BIT(1), 883 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK = BIT(2), 884 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT = BIT(3), 885 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT = BIT(4), 886 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM = BIT(5), 887 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU = BIT(6), 888 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED = BIT(7), 889 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED = BIT(8), 890 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK = BIT(9), 891 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU = BIT(10), 892 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK = BIT(11), 893 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE = BIT(12), 894 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK = BIT(13), 895 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP = BIT(14), 896 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED = BIT(15), 897 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT = BIT(16), 898 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER = BIT(17), 899 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES = BIT(18), 900 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION = BIT(19), 901 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX = BIT(20), 902 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX = BIT(21), 903 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC = BIT(22), 904 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC = BIT(23) | BIT(24), 905 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN = BIT(25), 906 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE = BIT(26), 907 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE = BIT(27), 908 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP = BIT(28), 909 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE = BIT(29), 910 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG = BIT(30), 911 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED = BIT(31), 912 }; 913 914 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT 23 915 916 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS 917 918 /** 919 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control 920 * 921 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control 922 * protocol frame (e.g. EAP) 923 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll 924 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD). 925 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information 926 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame 927 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path 928 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup 929 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211, 930 * used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before 931 * it can be sent out. 932 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that 933 * has already been assigned to this frame. 934 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered 935 * relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent 936 * of their QoS TID or other priority field values. 937 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally 938 * for sequence number assignment 939 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SCAN_TX: Indicates that this frame is transmitted 940 * due to scanning, not in normal operation on the interface. 941 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this 942 * frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is 943 * only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is 944 * also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame 945 * is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if 946 * it's intended for an MLD. 947 * 948 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags. 949 */ 950 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags { 951 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO = BIT(0), 952 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE = BIT(1), 953 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT = BIT(2), 954 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU = BIT(3), 955 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT = BIT(4), 956 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP = BIT(5), 957 IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING = BIT(6), 958 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO = BIT(7), 959 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER = BIT(8), 960 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX = BIT(9), 961 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SCAN_TX = BIT(10), 962 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK = 0xf0000000, 963 }; 964 965 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED 0xf 966 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC \ 967 u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \ 968 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK) 969 970 /** 971 * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status 972 * 973 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid 974 * 975 * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags. 976 */ 977 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags { 978 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0), 979 }; 980 981 /* 982 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are 983 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack. 984 */ 985 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK | \ 986 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT | \ 987 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU | \ 988 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK | \ 989 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK | \ 990 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER | \ 991 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC | \ 992 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP) 993 994 /** 995 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the 996 * Rate Control algorithm. 997 * 998 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx, 999 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate. 1000 * 1001 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate. 1002 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required. 1003 * This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection. 1004 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble. 1005 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate. 1006 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split 1007 * into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number) 1008 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in 1009 * Greenfield mode. 1010 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz. 1011 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission 1012 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission 1013 * (80+80 isn't supported yet) 1014 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the 1015 * adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is 1016 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS. 1017 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate. 1018 */ 1019 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags { 1020 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS = BIT(0), 1021 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT = BIT(1), 1022 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(2), 1023 1024 /* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */ 1025 IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS = BIT(3), 1026 IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD = BIT(4), 1027 IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(5), 1028 IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA = BIT(6), 1029 IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI = BIT(7), 1030 IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS = BIT(8), 1031 IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(9), 1032 IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(10), 1033 }; 1034 1035 1036 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */ 1037 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40 1038 1039 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */ 1040 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24 1041 1042 /* maximum number of rate stages */ 1043 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES 4 1044 1045 /* maximum number of rate table entries */ 1046 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE 4 1047 1048 /** 1049 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status 1050 * 1051 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with 1052 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags) 1053 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate 1054 * 1055 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used 1056 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried. 1057 * 1058 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should 1059 * always report the rate along with the flags it used. 1060 * 1061 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs 1062 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate 1063 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example, 1064 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the 1065 * information:: 1066 * 1067 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 } 1068 * 1069 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted 1070 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four 1071 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets 1072 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status 1073 * information should then contain:: 1074 * 1075 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ... 1076 * 1077 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2 1078 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement. 1079 */ 1080 struct ieee80211_tx_rate { 1081 s8 idx; 1082 u16 count:5, 1083 flags:11; 1084 } __packed; 1085 1086 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY 31 1087 1088 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate, 1089 u8 mcs, u8 nss) 1090 { 1091 WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF); 1092 WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7); 1093 rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs; 1094 } 1095 1096 static inline u8 1097 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate) 1098 { 1099 return rate->idx & 0xF; 1100 } 1101 1102 static inline u8 1103 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate) 1104 { 1105 return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1; 1106 } 1107 1108 /** 1109 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information 1110 * 1111 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses: 1112 * (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do 1113 * (2) driver internal use (if applicable) 1114 * (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened 1115 * 1116 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above 1117 * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races), 1118 * not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which 1119 * link the frame will be transmitted on 1120 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC 1121 * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally 1122 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally 1123 * @control: union part for control data 1124 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try 1125 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS 1126 * @control.use_rts: use RTS 1127 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS 1128 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only) 1129 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table 1130 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients 1131 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL) 1132 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL) 1133 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags 1134 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs) 1135 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space 1136 * @pad: padding 1137 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates 1138 * @status: union part for status data 1139 * @status.rates: attempted rates 1140 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal 1141 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length 1142 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length 1143 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy) 1144 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only 1145 * used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness 1146 * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags 1147 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area 1148 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data 1149 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK 1150 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers 1151 * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames. 1152 * relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set. 1153 * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames. 1154 * relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set. 1155 * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame 1156 */ 1157 struct ieee80211_tx_info { 1158 /* common information */ 1159 u32 flags; 1160 u32 band:3, 1161 ack_frame_id:13, 1162 hw_queue:4, 1163 tx_time_est:10; 1164 /* 2 free bits */ 1165 1166 union { 1167 struct { 1168 union { 1169 /* rate control */ 1170 struct { 1171 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[ 1172 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES]; 1173 s8 rts_cts_rate_idx; 1174 u8 use_rts:1; 1175 u8 use_cts_prot:1; 1176 u8 short_preamble:1; 1177 u8 skip_table:1; 1178 /* 2 bytes free */ 1179 }; 1180 /* only needed before rate control */ 1181 unsigned long jiffies; 1182 }; 1183 /* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */ 1184 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 1185 struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key; 1186 u32 flags; 1187 codel_time_t enqueue_time; 1188 } control; 1189 struct { 1190 u64 cookie; 1191 } ack; 1192 struct { 1193 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES]; 1194 s32 ack_signal; 1195 u8 ampdu_ack_len; 1196 u8 ampdu_len; 1197 u8 antenna; 1198 u8 pad; 1199 u16 tx_time; 1200 u8 flags; 1201 u8 pad2; 1202 void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)]; 1203 } status; 1204 struct { 1205 struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[ 1206 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES]; 1207 u8 pad[4]; 1208 1209 void *rate_driver_data[ 1210 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)]; 1211 }; 1212 void *driver_data[ 1213 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)]; 1214 }; 1215 }; 1216 1217 static inline u16 1218 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est) 1219 { 1220 /* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime 1221 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1 1222 */ 1223 info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2; 1224 return info->tx_time_est << 2; 1225 } 1226 1227 static inline u16 1228 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info) 1229 { 1230 return info->tx_time_est << 2; 1231 } 1232 1233 /*** 1234 * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path 1235 * 1236 * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a 1237 * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet. 1238 * 1239 * @rate_idx The actual used rate. 1240 * @try_count How often the rate was tried. 1241 * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the 1242 * corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level 1243 * that was used when sending the packet. 1244 */ 1245 struct ieee80211_rate_status { 1246 struct rate_info rate_idx; 1247 u8 try_count; 1248 u8 tx_power_idx; 1249 }; 1250 1251 /** 1252 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control 1253 * 1254 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for 1255 * @info: Basic tx status information 1256 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver) 1257 * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet 1258 * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates) 1259 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver 1260 * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds 1261 * Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action 1262 * frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled. 1263 */ 1264 struct ieee80211_tx_status { 1265 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 1266 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info; 1267 struct sk_buff *skb; 1268 struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates; 1269 ktime_t ack_hwtstamp; 1270 u8 n_rates; 1271 1272 struct list_head *free_list; 1273 }; 1274 1275 /** 1276 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs 1277 * 1278 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan 1279 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace 1280 * and the ones generated by mac80211. 1281 * 1282 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs. 1283 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs. 1284 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones) 1285 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies 1286 */ 1287 struct ieee80211_scan_ies { 1288 const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 1289 size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 1290 const u8 *common_ies; 1291 size_t common_ie_len; 1292 }; 1293 1294 1295 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb) 1296 { 1297 return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb; 1298 } 1299 1300 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb) 1301 { 1302 return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb; 1303 } 1304 1305 /** 1306 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status 1307 * 1308 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared. 1309 * 1310 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report 1311 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything 1312 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear 1313 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway). 1314 * 1315 * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the 1316 * driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore 1317 * any fields it needs after calling this helper. 1318 */ 1319 static inline void 1320 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info) 1321 { 1322 int i; 1323 1324 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 1325 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates)); 1326 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 1327 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates)); 1328 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8); 1329 /* clear the rate counts */ 1330 for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++) 1331 info->status.rates[i].count = 0; 1332 memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates); 1333 } 1334 1335 1336 /** 1337 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags 1338 * 1339 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status. 1340 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame. 1341 * Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED. 1342 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware. 1343 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame, 1344 * verification has been done by the hardware. 1345 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame. 1346 * If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection 1347 * hence the driver or hardware will have to do that. 1348 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this 1349 * flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection. 1350 * Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame 1351 * is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set) 1352 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did 1353 * de-duplication by itself. 1354 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on 1355 * the frame. 1356 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on 1357 * the frame. 1358 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime 1359 * field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU 1360 * was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS 1361 * merging. 1362 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime 1363 * field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU 1364 * (including FCS) was received. 1365 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime 1366 * field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received. 1367 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present. 1368 * Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU) 1369 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference 1370 * number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for 1371 * each A-MPDU 1372 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all 1373 * subframes of a single A-MPDU 1374 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU 1375 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected 1376 * on this subframe 1377 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC 1378 * is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field) 1379 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was 1380 * done by the hardware 1381 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without 1382 * processing it in any regular way. 1383 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report 1384 * them for sniffing purposes. 1385 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except 1386 * monitor interfaces. 1387 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report 1388 * them for sniffing purposes. 1389 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU 1390 * subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons. 1391 * All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g. 1392 * if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while 1393 * the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to 1394 * deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU 1395 * subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be 1396 * either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be 1397 * interleaved with other frames. 1398 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the 1399 * skb->data (before the 802.11 header). 1400 * If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point 1401 * to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV 1402 * data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs 1403 * in the skb. 1404 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before. 1405 * This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as 1406 * the first subframe. 1407 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must 1408 * be done in the hardware. 1409 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this 1410 * frame 1411 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known 1412 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present 1413 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in 1414 * 1415 * - DATA3_DATA_MCS 1416 * - DATA3_DATA_DCM 1417 * - DATA3_CODING 1418 * - DATA5_GI 1419 * - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC 1420 * - DATA6_NSTS 1421 * - DATA3_STBC 1422 * 1423 * from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data) 1424 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present 1425 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu) 1426 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present 1427 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with 1428 * the "0-length PSDU" field included there. The value for it is 1429 * in &struct ieee80211_rx_status. Note that if this value isn't 1430 * known the frame shouldn't be reported. 1431 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by 1432 * hardware or driver) 1433 */ 1434 enum mac80211_rx_flags { 1435 RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR = BIT(0), 1436 RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED = BIT(1), 1437 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START = BIT(2), 1438 RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED = BIT(3), 1439 RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED = BIT(4), 1440 RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC = BIT(5), 1441 RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC = BIT(6), 1442 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START = BIT(7), 1443 RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL = BIT(8), 1444 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS = BIT(9), 1445 RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED = BIT(10), 1446 RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED = BIT(11), 1447 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN = BIT(12), 1448 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST = BIT(13), 1449 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR = BIT(14), 1450 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN = BIT(15), 1451 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END = BIT(16), 1452 RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR = BIT(17), 1453 RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR = BIT(18), 1454 RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE = BIT(19), 1455 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END = BIT(20), 1456 RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED = BIT(21), 1457 RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN = BIT(22), 1458 RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED = BIT(23), 1459 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT = BIT(24), 1460 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN = BIT(25), 1461 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE = BIT(26), 1462 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU = BIT(27), 1463 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG = BIT(28), 1464 RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU = BIT(29), 1465 RX_FLAG_8023 = BIT(30), 1466 }; 1467 1468 /** 1469 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags 1470 * 1471 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame 1472 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used 1473 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission, 1474 * if the driver fills this value it should add 1475 * %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT 1476 * to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact. 1477 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used 1478 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3 1479 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed 1480 */ 1481 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags { 1482 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE = BIT(0), 1483 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI = BIT(2), 1484 RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF = BIT(3), 1485 RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK = BIT(4) | BIT(5), 1486 RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC = BIT(6), 1487 RX_ENC_FLAG_BF = BIT(7), 1488 }; 1489 1490 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT 4 1491 1492 enum mac80211_rx_encoding { 1493 RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0, 1494 RX_ENC_HT, 1495 RX_ENC_VHT, 1496 RX_ENC_HE, 1497 RX_ENC_EHT, 1498 }; 1499 1500 /** 1501 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status 1502 * 1503 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset 1504 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received 1505 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb). 1506 * 1507 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function 1508 * (TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware. 1509 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is 1510 * needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache. 1511 * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only 1512 * needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames. 1513 * Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled. 1514 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use 1515 * it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation 1516 * @band: the active band when this frame was received 1517 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz 1518 * This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed 1519 * for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting. 1520 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz. 1521 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or 1522 * unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags 1523 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_* 1524 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength 1525 * values were filled. 1526 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't 1527 * support dB or unspecified units) 1528 * @antenna: antenna used 1529 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if 1530 * HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT) 1531 * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only) 1532 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\* 1533 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding 1534 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw 1535 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags 1536 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc 1537 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi 1538 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value 1539 * @eht: EHT specific rate information 1540 * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc 1541 * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi 1542 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211 1543 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for 1544 * each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU 1545 * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC 1546 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU 1547 * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag 1548 * is set only when connection is MLO. 1549 * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with 1550 * @link_valid. 1551 */ 1552 struct ieee80211_rx_status { 1553 u64 mactime; 1554 union { 1555 u64 boottime_ns; 1556 ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp; 1557 }; 1558 u32 device_timestamp; 1559 u32 ampdu_reference; 1560 u32 flag; 1561 u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1; 1562 u8 enc_flags; 1563 u8 encoding:3, bw:4; 1564 union { 1565 struct { 1566 u8 he_ru:3; 1567 u8 he_gi:2; 1568 u8 he_dcm:1; 1569 }; 1570 struct { 1571 u8 ru:4; 1572 u8 gi:2; 1573 } eht; 1574 }; 1575 u8 rate_idx; 1576 u8 nss; 1577 u8 rx_flags; 1578 u8 band; 1579 u8 antenna; 1580 s8 signal; 1581 u8 chains; 1582 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 1583 u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc; 1584 u8 zero_length_psdu_type; 1585 u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4; 1586 }; 1587 1588 static inline u32 1589 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status) 1590 { 1591 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) + 1592 (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0); 1593 } 1594 1595 /** 1596 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags 1597 * 1598 * Flags to define PHY configuration options 1599 * 1600 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this 1601 * to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets 1602 * or not, do not use instead of filter flags! 1603 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only). 1604 * This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2, 1605 * meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to 1606 * transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames. 1607 * Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states, 1608 * driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support" 1609 * for more. 1610 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set 1611 * the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but 1612 * may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will 1613 * be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but 1614 * it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active. 1615 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main 1616 * operating channel. 1617 */ 1618 enum ieee80211_conf_flags { 1619 IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR = (1<<0), 1620 IEEE80211_CONF_PS = (1<<1), 1621 IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE = (1<<2), 1622 IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL = (1<<3), 1623 }; 1624 1625 1626 /** 1627 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed 1628 * 1629 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed 1630 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed 1631 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed 1632 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed 1633 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed 1634 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed 1635 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed 1636 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed 1637 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used, 1638 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed. 1639 */ 1640 enum ieee80211_conf_changed { 1641 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS = BIT(1), 1642 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL = BIT(2), 1643 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR = BIT(3), 1644 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS = BIT(4), 1645 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER = BIT(5), 1646 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(6), 1647 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS = BIT(7), 1648 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE = BIT(8), 1649 }; 1650 1651 /** 1652 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode 1653 * 1654 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic 1655 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off 1656 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static 1657 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic 1658 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use 1659 */ 1660 enum ieee80211_smps_mode { 1661 IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC, 1662 IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF, 1663 IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC, 1664 IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC, 1665 1666 /* keep last */ 1667 IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES, 1668 }; 1669 1670 /** 1671 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device 1672 * 1673 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware. 1674 * 1675 * @flags: configuration flags defined above 1676 * 1677 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval 1678 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use 1679 * in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon 1680 * has been received and the DTIM period is known. 1681 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the 1682 * powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when 1683 * the CONF_PS flag is set. 1684 * 1685 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility 1686 * value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces 1687 * 1688 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to 1689 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled 1690 * 1691 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame 1692 * (a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11, 1693 * but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries 1694 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short" 1695 * frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the 1696 * number of transmissions not the number of retries 1697 * 1698 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that 1699 * %IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not 1700 * configured for an HT channel. 1701 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used, 1702 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed. 1703 */ 1704 struct ieee80211_conf { 1705 u32 flags; 1706 int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout; 1707 1708 u16 listen_interval; 1709 u8 ps_dtim_period; 1710 1711 u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count; 1712 1713 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1714 bool radar_enabled; 1715 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 1716 }; 1717 1718 /** 1719 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data 1720 * 1721 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch 1722 * operation. 1723 * 1724 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization 1725 * Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch 1726 * announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter 1727 * the driver passed into mac80211. 1728 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the 1729 * rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211. 1730 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the 1731 * scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP. 1732 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to 1733 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event 1734 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in 1735 * current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new 1736 * channel, expressed in TU. 1737 */ 1738 struct ieee80211_channel_switch { 1739 u64 timestamp; 1740 u32 device_timestamp; 1741 bool block_tx; 1742 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1743 u8 count; 1744 u32 delay; 1745 }; 1746 1747 /** 1748 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags 1749 * 1750 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering 1751 * on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups 1752 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality 1753 * monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor 1754 * connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and 1755 * provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached. 1756 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this 1757 * interface. This flag should be set during interface addition, 1758 * but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is 1759 * only valid for managed/station mode interfaces. 1760 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes 1761 * and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even 1762 * this is not pure P2P vif. 1763 * @IEEE80211_VIF_DISABLE_SMPS_OVERRIDE: disable user configuration of 1764 * SMPS mode via debugfs. 1765 */ 1766 enum ieee80211_vif_flags { 1767 IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER = BIT(0), 1768 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI = BIT(1), 1769 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD = BIT(2), 1770 IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE = BIT(3), 1771 IEEE80211_VIF_DISABLE_SMPS_OVERRIDE = BIT(4), 1772 }; 1773 1774 1775 /** 1776 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags 1777 * 1778 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled 1779 * The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211. 1780 * It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface. 1781 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload 1782 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled 1783 * The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to 1784 * mac80211. 1785 */ 1786 1787 enum ieee80211_offload_flags { 1788 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED = BIT(0), 1789 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR = BIT(1), 1790 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED = BIT(2), 1791 }; 1792 1793 /** 1794 * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration 1795 * @assoc: association status 1796 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not 1797 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created 1798 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by 1799 * offchannel/dynamic_ps operations. 1800 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true 1801 * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002k. 1802 * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in 1803 * P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002j. 1804 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The 1805 * may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here. 1806 * The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here 1807 * to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass. 1808 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this 1809 * may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list 1810 * array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case. 1811 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode. 1812 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid. 1813 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format). 1814 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the 1815 * hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what 1816 * your driver/device needs to do. 1817 * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections 1818 * (station mode only) 1819 */ 1820 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg { 1821 /* association related data */ 1822 bool assoc, ibss_joined; 1823 bool ibss_creator; 1824 bool ps; 1825 u16 aid; 1826 u16 eml_cap; 1827 u16 eml_med_sync_delay; 1828 1829 __be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN]; 1830 int arp_addr_cnt; 1831 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 1832 size_t ssid_len; 1833 bool s1g; 1834 bool idle; 1835 u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 1836 }; 1837 1838 /** 1839 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data 1840 * 1841 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver 1842 * use during the life of a virtual interface. 1843 * 1844 * @type: type of this virtual interface 1845 * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg 1846 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own 1847 * or the BSS we're associated to 1848 * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration, 1849 * indexed by link ID 1850 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO. 1851 * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO. 1852 * The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the 1853 * API calls meant for that purpose. 1854 * @dormant_links: bitmap of valid but disabled links, or 0 for non-MLO. 1855 * Must be a subset of valid_links. 1856 * @addr: address of this interface 1857 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p 1858 * interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively 1859 * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this 1860 * vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver 1861 * can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup 1862 * for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM) 1863 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface, 1864 * these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added 1865 * or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed 1866 * at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field 1867 * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface. 1868 * These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface, 1869 * .change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver 1870 * within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change 1871 * restrictions. 1872 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC 1873 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only 1874 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per 1875 * interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual 1876 * monitor interface (if that is requested.) 1877 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this 1878 * interface. 1879 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211 1880 * for this interface. 1881 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to 1882 * sizeof(void \*). 1883 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue 1884 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see 1885 * &enum ieee80211_offload_flags. 1886 * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled. 1887 */ 1888 struct ieee80211_vif { 1889 enum nl80211_iftype type; 1890 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg; 1891 struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf; 1892 struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 1893 u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links; 1894 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 1895 bool p2p; 1896 1897 u8 cab_queue; 1898 u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS]; 1899 1900 struct ieee80211_txq *txq; 1901 1902 netdev_features_t netdev_features; 1903 u32 driver_flags; 1904 u32 offload_flags; 1905 1906 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS 1907 struct dentry *debugfs_dir; 1908 #endif 1909 1910 bool probe_req_reg; 1911 bool rx_mcast_action_reg; 1912 1913 struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif; 1914 1915 /* must be last */ 1916 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 1917 }; 1918 1919 /** 1920 * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif 1921 * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested 1922 * Return: the usable link bitmap 1923 */ 1924 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 1925 { 1926 return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links; 1927 } 1928 1929 /** 1930 * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one 1931 * @vif: the vif 1932 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise. 1933 */ 1934 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 1935 { 1936 /* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */ 1937 return vif->valid_links != 0; 1938 } 1939 1940 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id) \ 1941 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++) \ 1942 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \ 1943 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \ 1944 (link = rcu_dereference((vif)->link_conf[link_id]))) 1945 1946 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 1947 { 1948 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH 1949 return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT; 1950 #endif 1951 return false; 1952 } 1953 1954 /** 1955 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev 1956 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for 1957 * 1958 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs 1959 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev. 1960 * 1961 * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't 1962 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor 1963 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.) 1964 */ 1965 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev); 1966 1967 /** 1968 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif 1969 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for 1970 * 1971 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs 1972 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif. 1973 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif. 1974 */ 1975 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 1976 1977 /** 1978 * lockdep_vif_mutex_held - for lockdep checks on link poiners 1979 * @vif: the interface to check 1980 */ 1981 static inline bool lockdep_vif_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 1982 { 1983 return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->mtx); 1984 } 1985 1986 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id) \ 1987 rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \ 1988 lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif)) 1989 1990 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id) \ 1991 rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \ 1992 lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif)) 1993 1994 /** 1995 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags 1996 * 1997 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver 1998 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf. 1999 * 2000 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the 2001 * driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this 2002 * particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs 2003 * will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC. 2004 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by 2005 * the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC 2006 * generation in software. 2007 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates 2008 * that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key. 2009 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a 2010 * CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames 2011 * (MFP) to be done in software. 2012 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver 2013 * if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV 2014 * itself should not be generated. Do not set together with 2015 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does 2016 * not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or 2017 * MIC. 2018 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received 2019 * management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware 2020 * crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames 2021 * properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and 2022 * fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with 2023 * RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the 2024 * %IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW. 2025 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the 2026 * driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation 2027 * only for management frames (MFP). 2028 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the 2029 * driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always 2030 * be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled. 2031 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for 2032 * a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with 2033 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key. 2034 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation. 2035 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver 2036 * for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number 2037 * generation only 2038 */ 2039 enum ieee80211_key_flags { 2040 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT = BIT(0), 2041 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV = BIT(1), 2042 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC = BIT(2), 2043 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE = BIT(3), 2044 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX = BIT(4), 2045 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE = BIT(5), 2046 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT = BIT(6), 2047 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM = BIT(7), 2048 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE = BIT(8), 2049 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX = BIT(9), 2050 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE = BIT(10), 2051 }; 2052 2053 /** 2054 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information 2055 * 2056 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by 2057 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops. 2058 * 2059 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver 2060 * wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be 2061 * encrypted in hardware. 2062 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector. 2063 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it 2064 * needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO) 2065 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags. 2066 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3) 2067 * @keylen: key material length 2068 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte) 2069 * data block: 2070 * - Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits) 2071 * - Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits) 2072 * - Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits) 2073 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type 2074 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type 2075 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys 2076 */ 2077 struct ieee80211_key_conf { 2078 atomic64_t tx_pn; 2079 u32 cipher; 2080 u8 icv_len; 2081 u8 iv_len; 2082 u8 hw_key_idx; 2083 s8 keyidx; 2084 u16 flags; 2085 s8 link_id; 2086 u8 keylen; 2087 u8 key[]; 2088 }; 2089 2090 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN 16 2091 2092 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff)) 2093 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff)) 2094 2095 /** 2096 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter 2097 * 2098 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order 2099 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2100 * reverse order than in packet) 2101 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2102 * reverse order than in packet) 2103 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2104 * reverse order than in packet) 2105 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2106 * reverse order than in packet) 2107 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys 2108 */ 2109 struct ieee80211_key_seq { 2110 union { 2111 struct { 2112 u32 iv32; 2113 u16 iv16; 2114 } tkip; 2115 struct { 2116 u8 pn[6]; 2117 } ccmp; 2118 struct { 2119 u8 pn[6]; 2120 } aes_cmac; 2121 struct { 2122 u8 pn[6]; 2123 } aes_gmac; 2124 struct { 2125 u8 pn[6]; 2126 } gcmp; 2127 struct { 2128 u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN]; 2129 u8 seq_len; 2130 } hw; 2131 }; 2132 }; 2133 2134 /** 2135 * enum set_key_cmd - key command 2136 * 2137 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this 2138 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added. 2139 * 2140 * @SET_KEY: a key is set 2141 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled 2142 */ 2143 enum set_key_cmd { 2144 SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY, 2145 }; 2146 2147 /** 2148 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state 2149 * 2150 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all, 2151 * this is a special state for add/remove transitions 2152 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state 2153 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated 2154 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated 2155 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X) 2156 */ 2157 enum ieee80211_sta_state { 2158 /* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */ 2159 IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST, 2160 IEEE80211_STA_NONE, 2161 IEEE80211_STA_AUTH, 2162 IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC, 2163 IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED, 2164 }; 2165 2166 /** 2167 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth 2168 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz 2169 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz 2170 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz 2171 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz 2172 * (including 80+80 MHz) 2173 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz 2174 * 2175 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized 2176 * correctly, the values must be sorted. 2177 */ 2178 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth { 2179 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0, 2180 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40, 2181 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80, 2182 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160, 2183 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320, 2184 }; 2185 2186 /** 2187 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table 2188 * 2189 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update 2190 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default. 2191 * Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control. 2192 */ 2193 struct ieee80211_sta_rates { 2194 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2195 struct { 2196 s8 idx; 2197 u8 count; 2198 u8 count_cts; 2199 u8 count_rts; 2200 u16 flags; 2201 } rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE]; 2202 }; 2203 2204 /** 2205 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration 2206 * 2207 * Used to configure txpower for station. 2208 * 2209 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames 2210 * to the STA. 2211 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power 2212 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC 2213 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power. 2214 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for 2215 * per peer TPC. 2216 */ 2217 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr { 2218 s16 power; 2219 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type; 2220 }; 2221 2222 /** 2223 * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links 2224 * 2225 * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the 2226 * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change. 2227 * 2228 * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes. 2229 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble. 2230 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply: 2231 * 2232 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the 2233 * A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes. 2234 * * If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal 2235 * size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes. 2236 * 2237 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level 2238 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section 2239 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2). 2240 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control. 2241 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID 2242 */ 2243 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates { 2244 u16 max_amsdu_len; 2245 2246 u16 max_rc_amsdu_len; 2247 u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS]; 2248 }; 2249 2250 /** 2251 * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info 2252 * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single) 2253 * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here. 2254 * 2255 * @sta: reference to owning STA 2256 * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr 2257 * in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different 2258 * from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr) 2259 * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink) 2260 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic) 2261 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates 2262 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities 2263 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities 2264 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA 2265 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities 2266 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA 2267 * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation 2268 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with 2269 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the 2270 * station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode 2271 * notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after 2272 * the station moves to associated state. 2273 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration 2274 * 2275 */ 2276 struct ieee80211_link_sta { 2277 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2278 2279 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 2280 u8 link_id; 2281 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 2282 2283 u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2284 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap; 2285 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap; 2286 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap; 2287 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa; 2288 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap; 2289 2290 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg; 2291 2292 u8 rx_nss; 2293 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth; 2294 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr; 2295 }; 2296 2297 /** 2298 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry 2299 * 2300 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly 2301 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in 2302 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must 2303 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly, 2304 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a 2305 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it. 2306 * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association 2307 * and holds pointers to various link STA's 2308 * 2309 * @addr: MAC address 2310 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP 2311 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU 2312 * that this station is allowed to transmit to us. 2313 * Can be modified by driver. 2314 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does, 2315 * otherwise always false) 2316 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to 2317 * sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information. 2318 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid 2319 * if wme is supported. The bits order is like in 2320 * IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*. 2321 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported. 2322 * @rates: rate control selection table 2323 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer 2324 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only 2325 * valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place. 2326 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not. 2327 * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station. 2328 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single 2329 * A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means 2330 * unlimited. 2331 * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links 2332 * For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA 2333 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it. 2334 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not. 2335 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) 2336 * is used for non-data frames 2337 * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link 2338 * specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through 2339 * link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA 2340 * the first added link STA will point to deflink. 2341 * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link, 2342 * i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and 2343 * would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO 2344 * STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to 2345 * @deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address 2346 * would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned 2347 * by the AP. 2348 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO 2349 */ 2350 struct ieee80211_sta { 2351 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 2352 u16 aid; 2353 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes; 2354 bool wme; 2355 u8 uapsd_queues; 2356 u8 max_sp; 2357 struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates; 2358 bool tdls; 2359 bool tdls_initiator; 2360 bool mfp; 2361 bool mlo; 2362 u8 max_amsdu_subframes; 2363 2364 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur; 2365 2366 bool support_p2p_ps; 2367 2368 struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1]; 2369 2370 u16 valid_links; 2371 struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink; 2372 struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 2373 2374 /* must be last */ 2375 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 2376 }; 2377 2378 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP 2379 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta); 2380 #else 2381 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta) 2382 { 2383 return true; 2384 } 2385 #endif 2386 2387 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id) \ 2388 rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id], \ 2389 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta)) 2390 2391 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id) \ 2392 rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id], \ 2393 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta)) 2394 2395 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id) \ 2396 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++) \ 2397 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \ 2398 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \ 2399 ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id))) 2400 2401 /** 2402 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command 2403 * 2404 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this 2405 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition. 2406 * 2407 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping 2408 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up 2409 */ 2410 enum sta_notify_cmd { 2411 STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE, 2412 }; 2413 2414 /** 2415 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data 2416 * 2417 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and 2418 * it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU. 2419 */ 2420 struct ieee80211_tx_control { 2421 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2422 }; 2423 2424 /** 2425 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue 2426 * 2427 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 2428 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue 2429 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue), 2430 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled) 2431 * @ac: the AC for this queue 2432 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size 2433 * 2434 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling 2435 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). 2436 */ 2437 struct ieee80211_txq { 2438 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 2439 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2440 u8 tid; 2441 u8 ac; 2442 2443 /* must be last */ 2444 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 2445 }; 2446 2447 /** 2448 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags 2449 * 2450 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to 2451 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning 2452 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting 2453 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule, 2454 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully. 2455 * 2456 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL: 2457 * The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be 2458 * controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm 2459 * should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace 2460 * will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control 2461 * algorithm. 2462 * Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of 2463 * callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have 2464 * the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config 2465 * @use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot 2466 * timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for 2467 * CCK frames. 2468 * 2469 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS: 2470 * Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include 2471 * the FCS at the end. 2472 * 2473 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING: 2474 * Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames 2475 * for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others 2476 * rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used 2477 * to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and 2478 * multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that 2479 * the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(). 2480 * 2481 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: 2482 * Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We 2483 * expect values between 0 and @max_signal. 2484 * If possible please provide dB or dBm instead. 2485 * 2486 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM: 2487 * Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from 2488 * one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized 2489 * between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set. 2490 * 2491 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT: 2492 * Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h 2493 * Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC 2494 * 2495 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION: 2496 * Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation. 2497 * 2498 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS: 2499 * Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep). 2500 * 2501 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK: 2502 * Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies 2503 * stack support for dynamic PS. 2504 * 2505 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS: 2506 * Hardware has support for dynamic PS. 2507 * 2508 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE: 2509 * Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w). 2510 * 2511 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS: 2512 * Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to 2513 * the stack. 2514 * 2515 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR: 2516 * The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including 2517 * periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss. 2518 * 2519 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC: 2520 * This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e. 2521 * dtim_period). 2522 * 2523 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports 2524 * per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If 2525 * the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not 2526 * to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still 2527 * possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag 2528 * only in that case. 2529 * 2530 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device 2531 * autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When 2532 * this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected 2533 * stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames. 2534 * Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure 2535 * the PS mode of connected stations. 2536 * 2537 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session 2538 * setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in 2539 * software. 2540 * 2541 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of 2542 * a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only 2543 * active interfaces. 2544 * 2545 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to 2546 * be created. It is expected user-space will create vifs as 2547 * desired (and thus have them named as desired). 2548 * 2549 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the 2550 * crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically 2551 * try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if 2552 * the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its 2553 * supported cipher suites. 2554 * 2555 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit, 2556 * this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration 2557 * for frames. 2558 * 2559 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface 2560 * queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC) 2561 * for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue 2562 * control for more details. 2563 * 2564 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate 2565 * selection table provided by the rate control algorithm. 2566 * 2567 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any 2568 * P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface 2569 * is supported. 2570 * 2571 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames 2572 * only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon. 2573 * 2574 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates 2575 * and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not 2576 * using aggregation for such frames.) 2577 * 2578 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA) 2579 * for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support 2580 * is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the 2581 * CSA frame. 2582 * 2583 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload 2584 * or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first. 2585 * 2586 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands 2587 * in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band. 2588 * 2589 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth 2590 * than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel. 2591 * 2592 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs 2593 * within A-MPDU. 2594 * 2595 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status 2596 * for sent beacons. 2597 * 2598 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each 2599 * station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified 2600 * by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station 2601 * from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time. 2602 * 2603 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the 2604 * reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in 2605 * order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session 2606 * timeout. 2607 * 2608 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX, 2609 * which implies using per-CPU station statistics. 2610 * 2611 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated 2612 * A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support. 2613 * When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must 2614 * limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting 2615 * max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta. 2616 * 2617 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list 2618 * skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU. 2619 * 2620 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event 2621 * by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such 2622 * drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver 2623 * is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout. 2624 * 2625 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself. 2626 * The stack will not do fragmentation. 2627 * The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well. 2628 * 2629 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on 2630 * TDLS links. 2631 * 2632 * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the 2633 * mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a 2634 * deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no 2635 * beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the 2636 * virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of 2637 * the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the 2638 * deauthentication frame might not be transmitted. 2639 * 2640 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't 2641 * support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug. 2642 * 2643 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of 2644 * course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with. 2645 * 2646 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT 2647 * extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if 2648 * the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW 2649 * but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver. 2650 * See also the documentation for that flag. 2651 * 2652 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all 2653 * MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use 2654 * TXQs to start with. 2655 * 2656 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU 2657 * length in tx status information 2658 * 2659 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID 2660 * 2661 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID 2662 * only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set. 2663 * 2664 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only 2665 * aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx 2666 * A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID. 2667 * 2668 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation 2669 * offload 2670 * 2671 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation 2672 * offload 2673 * 2674 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx 2675 * decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface. 2676 * If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real 2677 * usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to 2678 * the stack. 2679 * 2680 * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color 2681 * collision detection and doesn't need it in software. 2682 * 2683 * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting 2684 * multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that. 2685 * 2686 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays 2687 */ 2688 enum ieee80211_hw_flags { 2689 IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL, 2690 IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS, 2691 IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING, 2692 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC, 2693 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM, 2694 IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC, 2695 IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT, 2696 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION, 2697 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS, 2698 IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK, 2699 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS, 2700 IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE, 2701 IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF, 2702 IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF, 2703 IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL, 2704 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT, 2705 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS, 2706 IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR, 2707 IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL, 2708 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK, 2709 IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, 2710 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW, 2711 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE, 2712 IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF, 2713 IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY, 2714 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES, 2715 IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA, 2716 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS, 2717 IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS, 2718 IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW, 2719 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU, 2720 IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS, 2721 IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR, 2722 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER, 2723 IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS, 2724 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU, 2725 IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST, 2726 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK, 2727 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG, 2728 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA, 2729 IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, 2730 IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP, 2731 IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ, 2732 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW, 2733 IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ, 2734 IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN, 2735 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID, 2736 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID, 2737 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT, 2738 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD, 2739 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD, 2740 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP, 2741 IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION, 2742 IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX, 2743 2744 /* keep last, obviously */ 2745 NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS 2746 }; 2747 2748 /** 2749 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state 2750 * 2751 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware 2752 * information for an 802.11 PHY. 2753 * 2754 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this 2755 * 802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev 2756 * members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV() 2757 * and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported 2758 * bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here. 2759 * 2760 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use. 2761 * 2762 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use 2763 * along with this structure. 2764 * 2765 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags. 2766 * 2767 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb 2768 * for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.) 2769 * 2770 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb. 2771 * Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs. 2772 * 2773 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used 2774 * only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB 2775 * 2776 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval 2777 * that HW supports 2778 * 2779 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for 2780 * data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these 2781 * queues need to have configurable access parameters. 2782 * 2783 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware. 2784 * If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be 2785 * set before calling ieee80211_register_hw(). 2786 * 2787 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2788 * within &struct ieee80211_vif. 2789 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2790 * within &struct ieee80211_sta. 2791 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2792 * within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf. 2793 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2794 * within @struct ieee80211_txq. 2795 * 2796 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw 2797 * can handle. 2798 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages 2799 * the hw can report back. 2800 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage 2801 * 2802 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of 2803 * sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver 2804 * aggregation. 2805 * This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the 2806 * number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering 2807 * it shouldn't be set. 2808 * 2809 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an 2810 * aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll 2811 * advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if 2812 * the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N 2813 * with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012). 2814 * For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used. 2815 * 2816 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum 2817 * of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list. 2818 * 2819 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX 2820 * (if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set) 2821 * 2822 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW 2823 * reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't 2824 * include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only 2825 * adding _BW is supported today. 2826 * 2827 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports, 2828 * the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH. 2829 * Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values. 2830 * 2831 * @radiotap_he: HE radiotap validity flags 2832 * 2833 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the 2834 * @units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp 2835 * field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status 2836 * device_timestamp. 2837 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a 2838 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a 2839 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value. 2840 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the 2841 * radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set. 2842 * 2843 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created 2844 * from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211, 2845 * other features will be rejected during HW registration. 2846 * 2847 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate 2848 * for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery- 2849 * enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap. 2850 * Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means 2851 * that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means 2852 * neither enabled. 2853 * 2854 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may 2855 * deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA. 2856 * Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values. 2857 * 2858 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the 2859 * device. 2860 * 2861 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from 2862 * them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed, 2863 * unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers. 2864 * 2865 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while 2866 * refilling deficit of each TXQ. 2867 * 2868 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set. 2869 * 2870 * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware. 2871 * The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions. 2872 * The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level. 2873 * 2874 * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list. 2875 */ 2876 struct ieee80211_hw { 2877 struct ieee80211_conf conf; 2878 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2879 const char *rate_control_algorithm; 2880 void *priv; 2881 unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)]; 2882 unsigned int extra_tx_headroom; 2883 unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom; 2884 int vif_data_size; 2885 int sta_data_size; 2886 int chanctx_data_size; 2887 int txq_data_size; 2888 u16 queues; 2889 u16 max_listen_interval; 2890 s8 max_signal; 2891 u8 max_rates; 2892 u8 max_report_rates; 2893 u8 max_rate_tries; 2894 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes; 2895 u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes; 2896 u8 max_tx_fragments; 2897 u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue; 2898 u8 radiotap_mcs_details; 2899 u16 radiotap_vht_details; 2900 struct { 2901 int units_pos; 2902 s16 accuracy; 2903 } radiotap_timestamp; 2904 netdev_features_t netdev_features; 2905 u8 uapsd_queues; 2906 u8 uapsd_max_sp_len; 2907 u8 max_nan_de_entries; 2908 u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift; 2909 u8 weight_multiplier; 2910 u32 max_mtu; 2911 const s8 *tx_power_levels; 2912 u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx; 2913 }; 2914 2915 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 2916 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg) 2917 { 2918 return test_bit(flg, hw->flags); 2919 } 2920 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg) 2921 2922 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 2923 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg) 2924 { 2925 return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags); 2926 } 2927 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg) 2928 2929 /** 2930 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request 2931 * 2932 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie) 2933 * @req: cfg80211 request. 2934 */ 2935 struct ieee80211_scan_request { 2936 struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies; 2937 2938 /* Keep last */ 2939 struct cfg80211_scan_request req; 2940 }; 2941 2942 /** 2943 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters 2944 * 2945 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from 2946 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request 2947 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode 2948 * @status: channel-switch response status 2949 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received 2950 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame 2951 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame 2952 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template 2953 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb 2954 */ 2955 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params { 2956 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2957 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef; 2958 u8 action_code; 2959 u32 status; 2960 u32 timestamp; 2961 u16 switch_time; 2962 u16 switch_timeout; 2963 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb; 2964 u32 ch_sw_tm_ie; 2965 }; 2966 2967 /** 2968 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy 2969 * 2970 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query 2971 * 2972 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective 2973 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private 2974 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should 2975 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this 2976 * is already used internally by mac80211. 2977 * 2978 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy. 2979 */ 2980 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy); 2981 2982 /** 2983 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware 2984 * 2985 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for 2986 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device 2987 */ 2988 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev) 2989 { 2990 set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev); 2991 } 2992 2993 /** 2994 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware 2995 * 2996 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for 2997 * @addr: the address to set 2998 */ 2999 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr) 3000 { 3001 memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN); 3002 } 3003 3004 static inline struct ieee80211_rate * 3005 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 3006 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c) 3007 { 3008 if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0)) 3009 return NULL; 3010 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx]; 3011 } 3012 3013 static inline struct ieee80211_rate * 3014 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 3015 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c) 3016 { 3017 if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0) 3018 return NULL; 3019 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx]; 3020 } 3021 3022 static inline struct ieee80211_rate * 3023 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 3024 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx) 3025 { 3026 if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0) 3027 return NULL; 3028 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx]; 3029 } 3030 3031 /** 3032 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb 3033 * @hw: the hardware 3034 * @skb: the skb 3035 * 3036 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure 3037 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported. 3038 */ 3039 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb); 3040 3041 /** 3042 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration 3043 * 3044 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware 3045 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations. 3046 * 3047 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given 3048 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and 3049 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL 3050 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to 3051 * the station information for the peer for individual keys. 3052 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when 3053 * VLANs are configured for an access point. 3054 * 3055 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx 3056 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf 3057 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function. 3058 * 3059 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if 3060 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be 3061 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the 3062 * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range. 3063 * 3064 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is 3065 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if 3066 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the 3067 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software. 3068 * 3069 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed. 3070 * 3071 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key 3072 * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any 3073 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather 3074 * based on the receive flags. 3075 * 3076 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key 3077 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key() 3078 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate 3079 * keys. 3080 * 3081 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption 3082 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key 3083 * handler. 3084 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key. 3085 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The 3086 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did 3087 * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is 3088 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this 3089 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16. 3090 * 3091 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index 3092 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required 3093 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses). 3094 * 3095 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag 3096 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following 3097 * requirements: 3098 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211 3099 once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed, 3100 2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued 3101 at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits), 3102 3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command 3103 encrypted with the new key when also needing 3104 @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and 3105 4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted. 3106 Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver. 3107 */ 3108 3109 /** 3110 * DOC: Powersave support 3111 * 3112 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations. 3113 * 3114 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself, 3115 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware 3116 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode 3117 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status. 3118 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary, 3119 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required 3120 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when 3121 * it finds traffic directed to it. 3122 * 3123 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in 3124 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused 3125 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking 3126 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it 3127 * back to sleep at appropriate times. 3128 * 3129 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the 3130 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be 3131 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame. 3132 * 3133 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also 3134 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported 3135 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and 3136 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still 3137 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle 3138 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that 3139 * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that. 3140 * 3141 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the 3142 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a 3143 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to 3144 * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when 3145 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle 3146 * periods. 3147 * 3148 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling 3149 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS 3150 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally, 3151 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the 3152 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support 3153 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the 3154 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value 3155 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable 3156 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS 3157 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave. 3158 * 3159 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling 3160 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the 3161 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS 3162 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To 3163 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames 3164 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled. 3165 * 3166 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with 3167 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK. 3168 */ 3169 3170 /** 3171 * DOC: Beacon filter support 3172 * 3173 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups 3174 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that 3175 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly 3176 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the 3177 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That 3178 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information 3179 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed. 3180 * 3181 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER 3182 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support 3183 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When 3184 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the 3185 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss(). 3186 * 3187 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the 3188 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call 3189 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled 3190 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future. 3191 * 3192 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing 3193 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211 3194 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense 3195 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include 3196 * 3197 * - a list of information element IDs 3198 * - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element 3199 * 3200 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the 3201 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense 3202 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device 3203 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all 3204 * vendor information elements. 3205 * 3206 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information 3207 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon. 3208 * 3209 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing 3210 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing 3211 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and 3212 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136, 3213 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility 3214 * it could also include some currently unused IDs. 3215 * 3216 * 3217 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the 3218 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming 3219 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of 3220 * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when 3221 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above 3222 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be 3223 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement 3224 * them as the roaming algorithm requires. 3225 * 3226 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to 3227 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the 3228 * signal strength threshold checking. 3229 */ 3230 3231 /** 3232 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save 3233 * 3234 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve 3235 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism 3236 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009) 3237 * "11.2.3 SM power save". 3238 * 3239 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames 3240 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct 3241 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the 3242 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware 3243 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by 3244 * hardware flags. 3245 * 3246 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211 3247 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS 3248 * turned off otherwise. 3249 * 3250 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate 3251 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config() 3252 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to 3253 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP. 3254 */ 3255 3256 /** 3257 * DOC: Frame filtering 3258 * 3259 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper 3260 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when 3261 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption, 3262 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is 3263 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible. 3264 * 3265 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell 3266 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be 3267 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out. 3268 * 3269 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast() 3270 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list 3271 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces. 3272 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to 3273 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the 3274 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and 3275 * @total_flags with the new flag states. 3276 * 3277 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will 3278 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count 3279 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted 3280 * or dropped. 3281 * 3282 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared. 3283 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_ 3284 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore 3285 * the flag, but not clear it. 3286 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the 3287 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type 3288 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it). 3289 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware 3290 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes 3291 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them, 3292 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag. 3293 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well. 3294 */ 3295 3296 /** 3297 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients 3298 * 3299 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for 3300 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD. 3301 * There currently is no support for sAPSD. 3302 * 3303 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client 3304 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time. 3305 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but 3306 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies 3307 * the driver code. 3308 * 3309 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete 3310 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set, 3311 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for 3312 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames. 3313 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of 3314 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't 3315 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD. 3316 * 3317 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the 3318 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a 3319 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is, 3320 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is 3321 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this 3322 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to 3323 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will 3324 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The 3325 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its 3326 * @sta_notify callback. 3327 * 3328 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up, 3329 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period. 3330 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and 3331 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When 3332 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211 3333 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames 3334 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit 3335 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER 3336 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only 3337 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to 3338 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have 3339 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS. 3340 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is 3341 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer. 3342 * 3343 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by 3344 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them. 3345 * 3346 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi 3347 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up 3348 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being 3349 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong 3350 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be 3351 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to 3352 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can 3353 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it 3354 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames 3355 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again 3356 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked. 3357 * 3358 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any 3359 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is 3360 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any 3361 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up 3362 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when 3363 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service 3364 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called 3365 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are 3366 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting 3367 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames, 3368 * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if 3369 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames 3370 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the 3371 * buffers for those TIDs contain. 3372 * 3373 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may 3374 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must 3375 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that 3376 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid 3377 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released 3378 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp() 3379 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway. 3380 * 3381 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211 3382 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags 3383 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP) 3384 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame. 3385 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case. 3386 * 3387 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data 3388 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as 3389 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame 3390 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed. 3391 */ 3392 3393 /** 3394 * DOC: HW queue control 3395 * 3396 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static 3397 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This 3398 * was problematic for a few reasons: 3399 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames 3400 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly 3401 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames 3402 * 3403 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all 3404 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it 3405 * won't have the same problem with the software queues. 3406 * 3407 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability 3408 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do 3409 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif 3410 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will 3411 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and 3412 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors 3413 * the hardware queue. 3414 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue 3415 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.) 3416 * 3417 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual 3418 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to 3419 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a 3420 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have 3421 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios: 3422 * 3423 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3 3424 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7 3425 * after-DTIM queue for AP: 8 3426 * off-channel queue: 9 3427 * 3428 * It would then set up the hardware like this: 3429 * hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9 3430 * 3431 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows: 3432 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0 3433 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1 3434 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2 3435 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3 3436 * vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 3437 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7. 3438 * 3439 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second 3440 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC. 3441 * 3442 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 3443 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the 3444 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when 3445 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode. 3446 */ 3447 3448 /** 3449 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags 3450 * 3451 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be 3452 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the 3453 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested, 3454 * but this has negative impact on power consumption. 3455 * 3456 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested 3457 * by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by 3458 * multicast address. 3459 * 3460 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the 3461 * %RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them) 3462 * 3463 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set 3464 * the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them 3465 * 3466 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate 3467 * to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses 3468 * by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing 3469 * mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should 3470 * honour this flag if possible. 3471 * 3472 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this 3473 * station 3474 * 3475 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes 3476 * 3477 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames 3478 * 3479 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames 3480 * 3481 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames 3482 */ 3483 enum ieee80211_filter_flags { 3484 FIF_ALLMULTI = 1<<1, 3485 FIF_FCSFAIL = 1<<2, 3486 FIF_PLCPFAIL = 1<<3, 3487 FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC = 1<<4, 3488 FIF_CONTROL = 1<<5, 3489 FIF_OTHER_BSS = 1<<6, 3490 FIF_PSPOLL = 1<<7, 3491 FIF_PROBE_REQ = 1<<8, 3492 FIF_MCAST_ACTION = 1<<9, 3493 }; 3494 3495 /** 3496 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions 3497 * 3498 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in 3499 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed. 3500 * 3501 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation 3502 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by 3503 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer 3504 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away! 3505 * 3506 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation 3507 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation 3508 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either 3509 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or 3510 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status 3511 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after 3512 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special 3513 * status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE. 3514 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational 3515 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting 3516 * queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the 3517 * driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(). 3518 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets, 3519 * called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call 3520 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the 3521 * session is gone and removes the station. 3522 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped 3523 * but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and 3524 * now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers 3525 * should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called. 3526 */ 3527 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action { 3528 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START, 3529 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP, 3530 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START, 3531 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT, 3532 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH, 3533 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT, 3534 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL, 3535 }; 3536 3537 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1 3538 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2 3539 3540 /** 3541 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters 3542 * 3543 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action. 3544 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session 3545 * @tid: tid of the BA session 3546 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When 3547 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the 3548 * actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here. 3549 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size (number of subframes). Valid only when the 3550 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or 3551 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL 3552 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU. 3553 * valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL 3554 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to 3555 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START 3556 */ 3557 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params { 3558 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action; 3559 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 3560 u16 tid; 3561 u16 ssn; 3562 u16 buf_size; 3563 bool amsdu; 3564 u16 timeout; 3565 }; 3566 3567 /** 3568 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason 3569 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll 3570 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to 3571 * frame received on trigger-enabled AC 3572 */ 3573 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type { 3574 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL, 3575 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD, 3576 }; 3577 3578 /** 3579 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed 3580 * 3581 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit 3582 * to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station 3583 * information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40 3584 * flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes. 3585 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed. 3586 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer 3587 * changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about 3588 * the peer. 3589 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed 3590 * by the peer 3591 */ 3592 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed { 3593 IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0), 3594 IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED = BIT(1), 3595 IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED = BIT(2), 3596 IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED = BIT(3), 3597 }; 3598 3599 /** 3600 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type 3601 * 3602 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations, 3603 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other 3604 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa). 3605 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC 3606 * operations compared to other operations/flows. 3607 * 3608 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC. 3609 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required 3610 * for sending management frames offchannel. 3611 */ 3612 enum ieee80211_roc_type { 3613 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0, 3614 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX, 3615 }; 3616 3617 /** 3618 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type 3619 * 3620 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what 3621 * reconfiguration type was completed. 3622 * 3623 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type 3624 * (also due to resume() callback returning 1) 3625 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless 3626 * of wowlan configuration) 3627 */ 3628 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type { 3629 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART, 3630 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND, 3631 }; 3632 3633 /** 3634 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information 3635 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration, 3636 * only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method. 3637 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc) 3638 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only 3639 * used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only 3640 * valid for auth and (re)assoc. 3641 */ 3642 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info { 3643 u16 duration; 3644 u16 subtype; 3645 u8 success:1; 3646 }; 3647 3648 /** 3649 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver 3650 * 3651 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may 3652 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure 3653 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame. 3654 * 3655 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame. 3656 * skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header. 3657 * The low-level driver should send the frame out based on 3658 * configuration in the TX control data. This handler should, 3659 * preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately. 3660 * Must be atomic. 3661 * 3662 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware 3663 * is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on 3664 * frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.) 3665 * Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace, 3666 * or zero. 3667 * When the device is started it should not have a MAC address 3668 * to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device 3669 * is added. 3670 * Must be implemented and can sleep. 3671 * 3672 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware 3673 * is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least 3674 * it must turn off frame reception.) 3675 * May be called right after add_interface if that rejects 3676 * an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue 3677 * you should ensure to cancel it on this callback. 3678 * Must be implemented and can sleep. 3679 * 3680 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and 3681 * stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then 3682 * ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is 3683 * configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and 3684 * reconfigured at resume time. 3685 * The driver may also impose special conditions under which it 3686 * wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only 3687 * supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it 3688 * must return 1 from this function. 3689 * 3690 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is 3691 * now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully 3692 * functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is 3693 * to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211 3694 * will also go through the regular complete restart on resume. 3695 * 3696 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is 3697 * modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is 3698 * supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only 3699 * in suspend(). 3700 * 3701 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is 3702 * enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start 3703 * and @stop must be implemented. 3704 * The driver should perform any initialization it needs before 3705 * the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the 3706 * interface is given in the conf parameter. 3707 * The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a 3708 * negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.) 3709 * Must be implemented and can sleep. 3710 * 3711 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback 3712 * is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be 3713 * switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep. 3714 * Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be 3715 * found by the interface iteration callbacks. 3716 * 3717 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down. 3718 * The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface 3719 * and no monitor interfaces are present. 3720 * When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware 3721 * must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets, 3722 * the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the 3723 * MAC address of the device going away. 3724 * Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep. 3725 * 3726 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this 3727 * function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel. 3728 * This function should never fail but returns a negative error code 3729 * if it does. The callback can sleep. 3730 * 3731 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS 3732 * parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low 3733 * level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters). 3734 * This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless 3735 * for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which 3736 * of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback 3737 * can sleep. 3738 * Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed 3739 * are not implemented. 3740 * 3741 * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface 3742 * (MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the 3743 * lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.) 3744 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed. 3745 * The callback can sleep. 3746 * 3747 * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link 3748 * parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an 3749 * individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information. 3750 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id 3751 * parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for 3752 * non-MLO connections. 3753 * The callback can sleep. 3754 * 3755 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration. 3756 * This callback is optional, and its return value is passed 3757 * to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic. 3758 * 3759 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter. 3760 * See the section "Frame filtering" for more information. 3761 * This callback must be implemented and can sleep. 3762 * 3763 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter. 3764 * This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames 3765 * should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination 3766 * of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates 3767 * which flags are changed. 3768 * This callback can sleep. 3769 * 3770 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit 3771 * must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic. 3772 * 3773 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration" 3774 * This callback is only called between add_interface and 3775 * remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface 3776 * is enabled. 3777 * Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added. 3778 * The callback can sleep. 3779 * 3780 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration" 3781 * This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers 3782 * which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY. 3783 * The callback must be atomic. 3784 * 3785 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the 3786 * host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data 3787 * necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter. 3788 * After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify 3789 * userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(). 3790 * 3791 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for 3792 * WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP 3793 * offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it. 3794 * 3795 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start 3796 * the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel 3797 * configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's 3798 * registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure 3799 * that power save is disabled. 3800 * The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the 3801 * entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these 3802 * at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the 3803 * (extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable). 3804 * When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called; 3805 * note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to 3806 * any error unless this callback returned a negative error code. 3807 * This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1, 3808 * this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a 3809 * software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this 3810 * capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't 3811 * advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is. 3812 * The callback can sleep. 3813 * 3814 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan. 3815 * The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible), 3816 * but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call 3817 * ieee80211_scan_completed(). 3818 * This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new 3819 * scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended. 3820 * The callback can sleep. 3821 * 3822 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at 3823 * specific intervals. The driver must call the 3824 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results. 3825 * This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called. 3826 * 3827 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan. 3828 * In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called. 3829 * 3830 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan 3831 * is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification. 3832 * The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR, 3833 * the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it 3834 * can use this parameter. The callback can sleep. 3835 * 3836 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a 3837 * software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need 3838 * this notification. 3839 * The callback can sleep. 3840 * 3841 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics. 3842 * Returns zero if statistics are available. 3843 * The callback can sleep. 3844 * 3845 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does 3846 * IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the 3847 * IV/PN for the given key from hardware. 3848 * The callback must be atomic. 3849 * 3850 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this 3851 * if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the 3852 * stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG 3853 * should be set as well. 3854 * The callback can sleep. 3855 * 3856 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it) 3857 * The callback can sleep. 3858 * 3859 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station, 3860 * AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep. 3861 * 3862 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated 3863 * station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback 3864 * returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected; 3865 * no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing 3866 * the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed. 3867 * This callback can sleep. 3868 * 3869 * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files 3870 * when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within 3871 * a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep. 3872 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf 3873 * with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory. 3874 * 3875 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files 3876 * when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback 3877 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This 3878 * callback can sleep. 3879 * 3880 * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files 3881 * when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback 3882 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This 3883 * callback can sleep. 3884 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the 3885 * station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory. 3886 * 3887 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an 3888 * associated station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating 3889 * in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag 3890 * %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic. 3891 * 3892 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx 3893 * power for the station. 3894 * This callback can sleep. 3895 * 3896 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a 3897 * station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.) 3898 * This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove. 3899 * It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions 3900 * up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it 3901 * isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace 3902 * period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station. 3903 * See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed. 3904 * The callback can sleep. 3905 * 3906 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU 3907 * synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station 3908 * pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear 3909 * the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse 3910 * in @sta_state. 3911 * The callback can sleep. 3912 * 3913 * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be 3914 * used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits 3915 * from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected 3916 * in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver 3917 * uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since 3918 * otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly. 3919 * Must be atomic. 3920 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This 3921 * is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses 3922 * the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic. 3923 * 3924 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon 3925 * filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so 3926 * let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of 3927 * the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not 3928 * all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible. 3929 * Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211. 3930 * The callback can sleep. 3931 * 3932 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max), 3933 * bursting) for a hardware TX queue. 3934 * Returns a negative error code on failure. 3935 * The callback can sleep. 3936 * 3937 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently, 3938 * this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a 3939 * required function. 3940 * The callback can sleep. 3941 * 3942 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware. 3943 * Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a 3944 * required function. 3945 * The callback can sleep. 3946 * 3947 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the 3948 * firmware/hardware. Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between 3949 * calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up 3950 * as TSF delay. Is not a required function. 3951 * The callback can sleep. 3952 * 3953 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize 3954 * with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This 3955 * function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of 3956 * TSF synchronization. 3957 * The callback can sleep. 3958 * 3959 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us. 3960 * This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is 3961 * used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests. 3962 * Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon. 3963 * The callback can sleep. 3964 * 3965 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information 3966 * 3967 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also 3968 * need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration, 3969 * and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback. 3970 * The callback can sleep. 3971 * 3972 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified 3973 * in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout 3974 * accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout 3975 * estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for 3976 * coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep. 3977 * 3978 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may 3979 * be %NULL. The callback can sleep. 3980 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep. 3981 * 3982 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure 3983 * that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap 3984 * of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces 3985 * use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues. 3986 * If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped. 3987 * Note that vif can be NULL. 3988 * The callback can sleep. 3989 * 3990 * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for 3991 * the given station, as it's about to be removed. 3992 * The callback can sleep. 3993 * 3994 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel 3995 * switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this 3996 * callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate 3997 * completion of the channel switch. 3998 * 3999 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device. 4000 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may 4001 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL 4002 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX). 4003 * 4004 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant). 4005 * 4006 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must 4007 * call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note 4008 * that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw 4009 * offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted 4010 * normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the 4011 * duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call 4012 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(). 4013 * Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and 4014 * must be accepted in this case. 4015 * This callback may sleep. 4016 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is 4017 * aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep. 4018 * 4019 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes. 4020 * 4021 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes. 4022 * 4023 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware 4024 * queues before entering power save. 4025 * 4026 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection 4027 * when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled. 4028 * The callback can sleep. 4029 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See 4030 * &enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types. 4031 * The callback must be atomic. 4032 * 4033 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given 4034 * parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for 4035 * sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver 4036 * to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD. 4037 * Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check 4038 * if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than 4039 * the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in 4040 * the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the 4041 * more-data bit must always be set. 4042 * The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames 4043 * from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set. 4044 * In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the 4045 * @num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In 4046 * this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag 4047 * on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll 4048 * period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple 4049 * responses for a retried PS-poll frame. 4050 * In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be 4051 * bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send 4052 * at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for 4053 * setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the 4054 * service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP 4055 * on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function 4056 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP. 4057 * This callback must be atomic. 4058 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames 4059 * to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211 4060 * via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames 4061 * released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set 4062 * and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case 4063 * frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder 4064 * them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag 4065 * on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP 4066 * bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the 4067 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() function. 4068 * The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the 4069 * frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set. 4070 * This callback must be atomic. 4071 * 4072 * @get_et_sset_count: Ethtool API to get string-set count. 4073 * 4074 * @get_et_stats: Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats. 4075 * 4076 * @get_et_strings: Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats 4077 * and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets. 4078 * 4079 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association 4080 * before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is 4081 * bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated 4082 * yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any 4083 * transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's 4084 * powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a 4085 * management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the 4086 * driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response 4087 * and to be able to synchronize with the GO. 4088 * For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211 4089 * would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication 4090 * frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO. 4091 * The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return 4092 * mac80211 will transmit the frame right away. 4093 * Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info 4094 * data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the 4095 * driver the duration for which the operation is requested. 4096 * The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep. 4097 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously 4098 * transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data 4099 * is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used. 4100 * 4101 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending 4102 * a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's 4103 * channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS 4104 * setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP. 4105 * mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS 4106 * discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least 4107 * 2 * (DTIM period). 4108 * The callback is optional and can sleep. 4109 * 4110 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation. 4111 * This callback may sleep. 4112 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction. 4113 * This callback may sleep. 4114 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that 4115 * may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same 4116 * channel context with different settings 4117 * This callback may sleep. 4118 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound 4119 * to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping. 4120 * This callback may sleep. 4121 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being 4122 * unbound from vif. 4123 * This callback may sleep. 4124 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to 4125 * another, as specified in the list of 4126 * @ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according 4127 * to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode. 4128 * This callback may sleep. 4129 * 4130 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the 4131 * information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel 4132 * context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses 4133 * software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is 4134 * just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being 4135 * disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed. 4136 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface. 4137 * 4138 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and 4139 * during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed. 4140 * This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and 4141 * indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames). 4142 * This callback may sleep. 4143 * 4144 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed. 4145 * Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces. 4146 * This callback is optional; it must not sleep. 4147 * 4148 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel. 4149 * Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this 4150 * function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be 4151 * decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call 4152 * ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get() 4153 * get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is 4154 * 1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been 4155 * transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish(). 4156 * If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called, 4157 * since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway. 4158 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called 4159 * before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA 4160 * gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing 4161 * the driver to prepare for the channel switch. 4162 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called 4163 * after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the 4164 * driver to go back to a normal configuration. 4165 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called 4166 * when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the 4167 * driver to go back to a normal configuration. 4168 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called 4169 * when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with 4170 * CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count. 4171 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all 4172 * information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A 4173 * channel context is bound before this is called. 4174 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again. 4175 * 4176 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the 4177 * specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0 4178 * if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide. 4179 * 4180 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration 4181 * and hardware limits. 4182 * 4183 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver 4184 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations 4185 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The 4186 * driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of 4187 * the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation. 4188 * The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can 4189 * optionally copy the skb for further re-use. 4190 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both 4191 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes. 4192 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or 4193 * response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets 4194 * parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue 4195 * an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch 4196 * response template is provided, together with the location of the 4197 * switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within 4198 * the function call. 4199 * 4200 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue. 4201 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a 4202 * synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues 4203 * pending frames that were received prior to the control path action 4204 * currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet. 4205 * 4206 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one. 4207 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster. 4208 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf 4209 * contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters 4210 * are changed with respect to the last NAN config. 4211 * The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since 4212 * some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the 4213 * changed parameters. 4214 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in 4215 * cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of 4216 * this call. 4217 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call 4218 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with 4219 * NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal. 4220 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports 4221 * aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation 4222 * between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while 4223 * skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU. 4224 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available. 4225 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided. 4226 * 4227 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep) 4228 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep) 4229 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep. 4230 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer. 4231 * This callback may sleep. 4232 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags 4233 * This callback may sleep. 4234 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using 4235 * 4-address mode 4236 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings. 4237 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed 4238 * to use rx decapsulation offload 4239 * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer. 4240 * This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters 4241 * are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement. 4242 * The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of 4243 * twt structure. 4244 * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received 4245 * from the peer. 4246 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for 4247 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit 4248 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev. 4249 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime 4250 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected 4251 * radar channel. 4252 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to 4253 * disable background CAC/radar detection. 4254 * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to 4255 * resolve a path for hardware flow offloading 4256 * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while 4257 * removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer), 4258 * but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or 4259 * new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation. 4260 * The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures 4261 * that were already removed, in case they're needed. 4262 * This callback can sleep. 4263 * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to 4264 * @change_vif_links. This callback can sleep. 4265 * Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links, 4266 * i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero. 4267 * In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them. 4268 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is 4269 * not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of 4270 * that. 4271 * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware 4272 * flow offloading for flows originating from the vif. 4273 * Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid 4274 * at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown. 4275 */ 4276 struct ieee80211_ops { 4277 void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4278 struct ieee80211_tx_control *control, 4279 struct sk_buff *skb); 4280 int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4281 void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4282 #ifdef CONFIG_PM 4283 int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan); 4284 int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4285 void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled); 4286 #endif 4287 int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4288 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4289 int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4290 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4291 enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p); 4292 void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4293 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4294 int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed); 4295 void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4296 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4297 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info, 4298 u64 changed); 4299 void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4300 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4301 u64 changed); 4302 void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4303 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4304 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info, 4305 u64 changed); 4306 4307 int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4308 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf); 4309 void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4310 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf); 4311 4312 u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4313 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list); 4314 void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4315 unsigned int changed_flags, 4316 unsigned int *total_flags, 4317 u64 multicast); 4318 void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4319 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4320 unsigned int filter_flags, 4321 unsigned int changed_flags); 4322 int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4323 bool set); 4324 int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd, 4325 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4326 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key); 4327 void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4328 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4329 struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf, 4330 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4331 u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key); 4332 void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4333 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4334 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data); 4335 void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4336 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx); 4337 int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4338 struct ieee80211_scan_request *req); 4339 void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4340 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4341 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4342 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4343 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req, 4344 struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies); 4345 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4346 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4347 void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4348 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4349 const u8 *mac_addr); 4350 void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4351 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4352 int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4353 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats); 4354 void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4355 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key, 4356 struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); 4357 int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value); 4358 int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value); 4359 int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4360 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4361 int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4362 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4363 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS 4364 void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4365 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4366 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf, 4367 struct dentry *dir); 4368 void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4369 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4370 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4371 struct dentry *dir); 4372 void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4373 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4374 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta, 4375 struct dentry *dir); 4376 #endif 4377 void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4378 enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4379 int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4380 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4381 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4382 int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4383 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4384 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state, 4385 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state); 4386 void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4387 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4388 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4389 void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4390 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4391 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4392 u32 changed); 4393 void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4394 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4395 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4396 void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4397 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4398 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4399 struct station_info *sinfo); 4400 int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4401 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4402 unsigned int link_id, u16 ac, 4403 const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params); 4404 u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4405 void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4406 u64 tsf); 4407 void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4408 s64 offset); 4409 void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4410 int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4411 4412 /** 4413 * @ampdu_action: 4414 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action. 4415 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want 4416 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through 4417 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action. 4418 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver 4419 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size 4420 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the 4421 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be 4422 * possible with a buf_size of 8: 4423 * 4424 * - ``TX: 1.....7`` 4425 * - ``RX: 2....7`` (lost frame #1) 4426 * - ``TX: 8..1...`` 4427 * 4428 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the 4429 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be: 4430 * 4431 * - ``TX: 1 or`` 4432 * - ``TX: 18 or`` 4433 * - ``TX: 81`` 4434 * 4435 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again. 4436 * 4437 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return 4438 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START 4439 * if the session can start immediately. 4440 * 4441 * The callback can sleep. 4442 */ 4443 int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4444 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4445 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params); 4446 int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx, 4447 struct survey_info *survey); 4448 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4449 void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class); 4450 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 4451 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4452 void *data, int len); 4453 int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb, 4454 struct netlink_callback *cb, 4455 void *data, int len); 4456 #endif 4457 void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4458 u32 queues, bool drop); 4459 void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4460 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4461 void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4462 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4463 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch); 4464 int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant); 4465 int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant); 4466 4467 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4468 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4469 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 4470 int duration, 4471 enum ieee80211_roc_type type); 4472 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4473 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4474 int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx); 4475 void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4476 u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max); 4477 bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4478 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4479 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask); 4480 void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4481 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4482 const struct ieee80211_event *event); 4483 4484 void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4485 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4486 u16 tids, int num_frames, 4487 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason, 4488 bool more_data); 4489 void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4490 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4491 u16 tids, int num_frames, 4492 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason, 4493 bool more_data); 4494 4495 int (*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4496 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset); 4497 void (*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4498 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4499 struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data); 4500 void (*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4501 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4502 u32 sset, u8 *data); 4503 4504 void (*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4505 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4506 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info); 4507 void (*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4508 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4509 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info); 4510 4511 void (*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4512 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4513 4514 int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4515 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4516 void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4517 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4518 void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4519 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx, 4520 u32 changed); 4521 int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4522 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4523 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf, 4524 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4525 void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4526 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4527 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf, 4528 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4529 int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4530 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs, 4531 int n_vifs, 4532 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode); 4533 4534 void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4535 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type); 4536 4537 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6) 4538 void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4539 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4540 struct inet6_dev *idev); 4541 #endif 4542 void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4543 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4544 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4545 int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4546 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4547 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch); 4548 4549 int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4550 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4551 void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4552 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4553 void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4554 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4555 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch); 4556 4557 int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4558 void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4559 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4560 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4561 int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4562 int *dbm); 4563 4564 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4565 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4566 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class, 4567 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 4568 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie); 4569 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4570 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4571 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4572 void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4573 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4574 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params); 4575 4576 void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4577 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 4578 void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4579 4580 int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4581 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4582 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf); 4583 int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4584 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4585 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4586 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4587 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes); 4588 int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4589 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4590 const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func); 4591 void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4592 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4593 u8 instance_id); 4594 bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4595 struct sk_buff *head, 4596 struct sk_buff *skb); 4597 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4598 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4599 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats); 4600 int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4601 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4602 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4603 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4604 int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4605 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4606 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4607 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf); 4608 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4609 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4610 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids); 4611 void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4612 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4613 void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4614 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled); 4615 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4616 const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar); 4617 void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4618 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4619 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled); 4620 void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4621 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4622 struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt); 4623 void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4624 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid); 4625 int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4626 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4627 int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4628 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4629 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4630 struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx, 4631 struct net_device_path *path); 4632 int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4633 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4634 u16 old_links, u16 new_links, 4635 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]); 4636 int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4637 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4638 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4639 u16 old_links, u16 new_links); 4640 int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4641 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4642 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts); 4643 int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4644 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4645 struct net_device *dev, 4646 enum tc_setup_type type, 4647 void *type_data); 4648 }; 4649 4650 /** 4651 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device 4652 * 4653 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer 4654 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions. 4655 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by 4656 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as 4657 * @priv_data_len. 4658 * 4659 * @priv_data_len: length of private data 4660 * @ops: callbacks for this device 4661 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device. 4662 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d) 4663 * 4664 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error. 4665 */ 4666 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len, 4667 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops, 4668 const char *requested_name); 4669 4670 /** 4671 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device 4672 * 4673 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer 4674 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions. 4675 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by 4676 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as 4677 * @priv_data_len. 4678 * 4679 * @priv_data_len: length of private data 4680 * @ops: callbacks for this device 4681 * 4682 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error. 4683 */ 4684 static inline 4685 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len, 4686 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops) 4687 { 4688 return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL); 4689 } 4690 4691 /** 4692 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device 4693 * 4694 * You must call this function before any other functions in 4695 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you 4696 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information. 4697 * 4698 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw() 4699 * 4700 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise. 4701 */ 4702 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4703 4704 /** 4705 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description 4706 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec 4707 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds 4708 * (full cycle, ie. one off + one on period) 4709 */ 4710 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink { 4711 int throughput; 4712 int blink_time; 4713 }; 4714 4715 /** 4716 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags 4717 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio 4718 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working 4719 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one 4720 * interface is connected in some way, including being an AP 4721 */ 4722 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags { 4723 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO = BIT(0), 4724 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK = BIT(1), 4725 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED = BIT(2), 4726 }; 4727 4728 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4729 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4730 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4731 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4732 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4733 const char * 4734 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4735 unsigned int flags, 4736 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table, 4737 unsigned int blink_table_len); 4738 #endif 4739 /** 4740 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED 4741 * 4742 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4743 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4744 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4745 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4746 * 4747 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4748 * 4749 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4750 */ 4751 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4752 { 4753 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4754 return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw); 4755 #else 4756 return NULL; 4757 #endif 4758 } 4759 4760 /** 4761 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED 4762 * 4763 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4764 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4765 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4766 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4767 * 4768 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4769 * 4770 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4771 */ 4772 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4773 { 4774 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4775 return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw); 4776 #else 4777 return NULL; 4778 #endif 4779 } 4780 4781 /** 4782 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED 4783 * 4784 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4785 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4786 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4787 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4788 * 4789 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4790 * 4791 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4792 */ 4793 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4794 { 4795 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4796 return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw); 4797 #else 4798 return NULL; 4799 #endif 4800 } 4801 4802 /** 4803 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED 4804 * 4805 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4806 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4807 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4808 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4809 * 4810 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4811 * 4812 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4813 */ 4814 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4815 { 4816 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4817 return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw); 4818 #else 4819 return NULL; 4820 #endif 4821 } 4822 4823 /** 4824 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger 4825 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for 4826 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags 4827 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput 4828 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table 4829 * 4830 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are 4831 * configured) or the name of the new trigger. 4832 * 4833 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw(). 4834 */ 4835 static inline const char * 4836 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags, 4837 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table, 4838 unsigned int blink_table_len) 4839 { 4840 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4841 return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table, 4842 blink_table_len); 4843 #else 4844 return NULL; 4845 #endif 4846 } 4847 4848 /** 4849 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device 4850 * 4851 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources 4852 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem. 4853 * 4854 * @hw: the hardware to unregister 4855 */ 4856 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4857 4858 /** 4859 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor 4860 * 4861 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the 4862 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw() 4863 * before calling this function. 4864 * 4865 * @hw: the hardware to free 4866 */ 4867 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4868 4869 /** 4870 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely 4871 * 4872 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason 4873 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state 4874 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware 4875 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by 4876 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all 4877 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function. 4878 * 4879 * @hw: the hardware to restart 4880 */ 4881 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4882 4883 /** 4884 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list 4885 * 4886 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive 4887 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a 4888 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211 4889 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory 4890 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack. 4891 * 4892 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 4893 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to 4894 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be 4895 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 4896 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4897 * 4898 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock 4899 * 4900 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4901 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL 4902 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4903 * @list: the destination list 4904 */ 4905 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4906 struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list); 4907 4908 /** 4909 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context 4910 * 4911 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive 4912 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a 4913 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211 4914 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory 4915 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack. 4916 * 4917 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 4918 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to 4919 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be 4920 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 4921 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4922 * 4923 * This function must be called with BHs disabled. 4924 * 4925 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4926 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL 4927 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4928 * @napi: the NAPI context 4929 */ 4930 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4931 struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi); 4932 4933 /** 4934 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame 4935 * 4936 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive 4937 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a 4938 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211 4939 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory 4940 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack. 4941 * 4942 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 4943 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to 4944 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be 4945 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 4946 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4947 * 4948 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni(). 4949 * 4950 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4951 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4952 */ 4953 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb) 4954 { 4955 ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL); 4956 } 4957 4958 /** 4959 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame 4960 * 4961 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context 4962 * (internally defers to a tasklet.) 4963 * 4964 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not 4965 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with 4966 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4967 * 4968 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4969 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4970 */ 4971 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb); 4972 4973 /** 4974 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context) 4975 * 4976 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context 4977 * (internally disables bottom halves). 4978 * 4979 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may 4980 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 4981 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4982 * 4983 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4984 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4985 */ 4986 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4987 struct sk_buff *skb) 4988 { 4989 local_bh_disable(); 4990 ieee80211_rx(hw, skb); 4991 local_bh_enable(); 4992 } 4993 4994 /** 4995 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta 4996 * 4997 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS 4998 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station 4999 * entering/leaving PS mode. 5000 * 5001 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled. 5002 * 5003 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against 5004 * each other. 5005 * 5006 * @sta: currently connected sta 5007 * @start: start or stop PS 5008 * 5009 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set. 5010 */ 5011 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start); 5012 5013 /** 5014 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta 5015 * (in process context) 5016 * 5017 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context 5018 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still 5019 * applies. 5020 * 5021 * @sta: currently connected sta 5022 * @start: start or stop PS 5023 * 5024 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(). 5025 */ 5026 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5027 bool start) 5028 { 5029 int ret; 5030 5031 local_bh_disable(); 5032 ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start); 5033 local_bh_enable(); 5034 5035 return ret; 5036 } 5037 5038 /** 5039 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received 5040 * @sta: currently connected station 5041 * 5042 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set, 5043 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a 5044 * connected station was received. 5045 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() 5046 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must 5047 * be serialized. 5048 */ 5049 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 5050 5051 /** 5052 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received 5053 * @sta: currently connected station 5054 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame 5055 * 5056 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set, 5057 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame 5058 * from a connected station was received. 5059 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() 5060 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be 5061 * serialized. 5062 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown. 5063 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC 5064 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper 5065 * checks. 5066 */ 5067 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid); 5068 5069 /* 5070 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions. 5071 * This is enough for the radiotap header. 5072 */ 5073 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM ALIGN(14, 4) 5074 5075 /** 5076 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames 5077 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station 5078 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames 5079 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID 5080 * 5081 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing 5082 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need 5083 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit. 5084 * 5085 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are 5086 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data 5087 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim 5088 * call! Beware of the locking!) 5089 * 5090 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD) 5091 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are 5092 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes 5093 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data, 5094 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered 5095 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP). 5096 * 5097 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per 5098 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since 5099 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the 5100 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that 5101 * use this API. 5102 */ 5103 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5104 u8 tid, bool buffered); 5105 5106 /** 5107 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet 5108 * 5109 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support 5110 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent 5111 * rate selection table for the station entry. 5112 * 5113 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5114 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent. 5115 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted. 5116 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information 5117 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch 5118 */ 5119 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5120 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5121 struct sk_buff *skb, 5122 struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest, 5123 int max_rates); 5124 5125 /** 5126 * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station 5127 * 5128 * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput 5129 * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can 5130 * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station 5131 * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic 5132 * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause 5133 * slow stations to starve). 5134 * 5135 * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for. 5136 * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps. 5137 */ 5138 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, 5139 u32 thr); 5140 5141 /** 5142 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback 5143 * 5144 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta 5145 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision 5146 * in updating the tx rate in data path. 5147 * 5148 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5149 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for. 5150 * @info: tx status information 5151 */ 5152 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5153 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, 5154 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info); 5155 5156 /** 5157 * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback 5158 * 5159 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been 5160 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for 5161 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics. 5162 * 5163 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 5164 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls 5165 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() 5166 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 5167 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni(). 5168 * 5169 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5170 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call 5171 */ 5172 void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5173 struct sk_buff *skb); 5174 5175 /** 5176 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback 5177 * 5178 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status 5179 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not 5180 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info. 5181 * 5182 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized 5183 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() 5184 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware. 5185 * 5186 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5187 * @status: tx status information 5188 */ 5189 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5190 struct ieee80211_tx_status *status); 5191 5192 /** 5193 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb 5194 * 5195 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status 5196 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to 5197 * specific skbs. 5198 * 5199 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized 5200 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() 5201 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware. 5202 * 5203 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5204 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent 5205 * (NULL for multicast packets) 5206 * @info: tx status information 5207 */ 5208 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5209 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5210 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info) 5211 { 5212 struct ieee80211_tx_status status = { 5213 .sta = sta, 5214 .info = info, 5215 }; 5216 5217 ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status); 5218 } 5219 5220 /** 5221 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context) 5222 * 5223 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context. 5224 * 5225 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and 5226 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed 5227 * for a single hardware. 5228 * 5229 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5230 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call 5231 */ 5232 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5233 struct sk_buff *skb) 5234 { 5235 local_bh_disable(); 5236 ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb); 5237 local_bh_enable(); 5238 } 5239 5240 /** 5241 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback 5242 * 5243 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context 5244 * (internally defers to a tasklet.) 5245 * 5246 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and 5247 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware. 5248 * 5249 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5250 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call 5251 */ 5252 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5253 struct sk_buff *skb); 5254 5255 /** 5256 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station 5257 * 5258 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding 5259 * connected STA. 5260 * 5261 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta 5262 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response 5263 */ 5264 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets); 5265 5266 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2 5267 5268 /** 5269 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets 5270 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element 5271 * @tim_length: size of TIM element 5272 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets 5273 * to countdown counters. This array can contain zero values which 5274 * should be ignored. 5275 * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element 5276 */ 5277 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets { 5278 u16 tim_offset; 5279 u16 tim_length; 5280 5281 u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM]; 5282 u16 mbssid_off; 5283 }; 5284 5285 /** 5286 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function 5287 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5288 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5289 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will 5290 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver. 5291 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA 5292 * that is not associated with AP MLD). 5293 * 5294 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to 5295 * obtain the beacon template. 5296 * 5297 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the 5298 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template 5299 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when 5300 * applicable, the CSA count. 5301 * 5302 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 5303 * 5304 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error. 5305 */ 5306 struct sk_buff * 5307 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5308 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5309 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs, 5310 unsigned int link_id); 5311 5312 /** 5313 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation 5314 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5315 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5316 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will 5317 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver. 5318 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP). 5319 * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set. 5320 * 5321 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template() 5322 * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the 5323 * requested index. 5324 * 5325 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates. 5326 */ 5327 struct sk_buff * 5328 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5329 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5330 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs, 5331 unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index); 5332 5333 /** 5334 * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons 5335 * @cnt: count of EMA beacons. 5336 * 5337 * @bcn: array of EMA beacons. 5338 * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon 5339 * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will 5340 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver. 5341 */ 5342 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons { 5343 u8 cnt; 5344 struct { 5345 struct sk_buff *skb; 5346 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs; 5347 } bcn[]; 5348 }; 5349 5350 /** 5351 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation 5352 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5353 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5354 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP) 5355 * 5356 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template() 5357 * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required 5358 * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only 5359 * one multiple BSSID element. 5360 * 5361 * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory. 5362 * 5363 * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *. 5364 * %NULL on error. 5365 */ 5366 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons * 5367 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5368 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5369 unsigned int link_id); 5370 5371 /** 5372 * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list 5373 * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers. 5374 * 5375 * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling 5376 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list() 5377 */ 5378 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons); 5379 5380 /** 5381 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function 5382 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5383 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5384 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset. 5385 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes). 5386 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length, 5387 * (including the ID and length bytes!). 5388 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes). 5389 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA 5390 * that is not associated with AP MLD). 5391 * 5392 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to 5393 * obtain the beacon frame. 5394 * 5395 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in 5396 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon 5397 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly 5398 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt). 5399 * 5400 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 5401 * 5402 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error. 5403 */ 5404 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5405 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5406 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length, 5407 unsigned int link_id); 5408 5409 /** 5410 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function 5411 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5412 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5413 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA 5414 * that is not associated with AP MLD). 5415 * 5416 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(). 5417 * 5418 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(). 5419 */ 5420 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5421 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5422 unsigned int link_id) 5423 { 5424 return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id); 5425 } 5426 5427 /** 5428 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown 5429 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5430 * 5431 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission. 5432 * This function is called implicitly when 5433 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the 5434 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this 5435 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown. 5436 * 5437 * Return: new countdown value 5438 */ 5439 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5440 5441 /** 5442 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown 5443 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5444 * @counter: the new value for the counter 5445 * 5446 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be 5447 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211. 5448 * 5449 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(), 5450 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value. 5451 */ 5452 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter); 5453 5454 /** 5455 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch 5456 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5457 * 5458 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this 5459 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to 5460 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed. 5461 */ 5462 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5463 5464 /** 5465 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1 5466 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5467 * 5468 * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero. 5469 */ 5470 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5471 5472 /** 5473 * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change 5474 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5475 * 5476 * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this 5477 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to 5478 * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed 5479 */ 5480 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5481 5482 /** 5483 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template 5484 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5485 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5486 * 5487 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to 5488 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller. 5489 * 5490 * Can only be called in AP mode. 5491 * 5492 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error. 5493 */ 5494 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5495 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5496 5497 /** 5498 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template 5499 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5500 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5501 * 5502 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to 5503 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct 5504 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used. 5505 * 5506 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the 5507 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit. 5508 * 5509 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error. 5510 */ 5511 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5512 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5513 5514 /** 5515 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template 5516 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5517 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5518 * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses 5519 * for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with 5520 * MLD addresses, however useful that might be. 5521 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set 5522 * if at all possible 5523 * 5524 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to 5525 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct 5526 * BSSID and address is used. 5527 * 5528 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the 5529 * returned packet will be QoS NDP. 5530 * 5531 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the 5532 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields. 5533 * 5534 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error. 5535 */ 5536 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5537 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5538 int link_id, bool qos_ok); 5539 5540 /** 5541 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template 5542 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5543 * @src_addr: source MAC address 5544 * @ssid: SSID buffer 5545 * @ssid_len: length of SSID 5546 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs 5547 * 5548 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to 5549 * hardware. 5550 * 5551 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error. 5552 */ 5553 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5554 const u8 *src_addr, 5555 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len, 5556 size_t tailroom); 5557 5558 /** 5559 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function 5560 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5561 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5562 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS. 5563 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets). 5564 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5565 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame. 5566 * 5567 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in 5568 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5569 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible 5570 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed. 5571 */ 5572 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5573 const void *frame, size_t frame_len, 5574 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl, 5575 struct ieee80211_rts *rts); 5576 5577 /** 5578 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame 5579 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5580 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5581 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS. 5582 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5583 * 5584 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide 5585 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5586 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder. 5587 * 5588 * Return: The duration. 5589 */ 5590 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5591 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len, 5592 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl); 5593 5594 /** 5595 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function 5596 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5597 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5598 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self. 5599 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets). 5600 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5601 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame. 5602 * 5603 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in 5604 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5605 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible 5606 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed. 5607 */ 5608 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5609 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5610 const void *frame, size_t frame_len, 5611 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl, 5612 struct ieee80211_cts *cts); 5613 5614 /** 5615 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame 5616 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5617 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5618 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self. 5619 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5620 * 5621 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide 5622 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5623 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder. 5624 * 5625 * Return: The duration. 5626 */ 5627 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5628 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5629 size_t frame_len, 5630 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl); 5631 5632 /** 5633 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame 5634 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5635 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5636 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on 5637 * @frame_len: the length of the frame. 5638 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted. 5639 * 5640 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its 5641 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps). 5642 * 5643 * Return: The duration. 5644 */ 5645 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5646 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5647 enum nl80211_band band, 5648 size_t frame_len, 5649 struct ieee80211_rate *rate); 5650 5651 /** 5652 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames 5653 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5654 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5655 * 5656 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If 5657 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast 5658 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host 5659 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered 5660 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame. 5661 * 5662 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered 5663 * frames are available. 5664 * 5665 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was 5666 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus 5667 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns 5668 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver 5669 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to 5670 * use common code for all beacons. 5671 */ 5672 struct sk_buff * 5673 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5674 5675 /** 5676 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32 5677 * 5678 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32. 5679 * 5680 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5681 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for 5682 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values 5683 */ 5684 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5685 u32 iv32, u16 *p1k); 5686 5687 /** 5688 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key 5689 * 5690 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken 5691 * from the given packet. 5692 * 5693 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5694 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted 5695 * with this P1K 5696 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values 5697 */ 5698 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5699 struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k) 5700 { 5701 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data; 5702 const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control); 5703 u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]); 5704 5705 ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k); 5706 } 5707 5708 /** 5709 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX 5710 * 5711 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32 5712 * and transmitter address. 5713 * 5714 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5715 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key 5716 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for 5717 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values 5718 */ 5719 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5720 const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k); 5721 5722 /** 5723 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key 5724 * 5725 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values 5726 * in the packet. 5727 * 5728 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5729 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be 5730 * encrypted with this key 5731 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes 5732 */ 5733 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5734 struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k); 5735 5736 /** 5737 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos 5738 * 5739 * @pos: start of crypto header 5740 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5741 * @pn: PN to add 5742 * 5743 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of 5744 * the packet payload) 5745 * 5746 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should 5747 * point to the crypto header) 5748 */ 5749 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn); 5750 5751 /** 5752 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter 5753 * 5754 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5755 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only); 5756 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For 5757 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid. 5758 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data 5759 * 5760 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs 5761 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done 5762 * by the device and not by mac80211. 5763 * 5764 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing 5765 * can be done concurrently. 5766 */ 5767 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5768 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); 5769 5770 /** 5771 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter 5772 * 5773 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5774 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only); 5775 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For 5776 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid. 5777 * @seq: new sequence data 5778 * 5779 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the 5780 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK 5781 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called 5782 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211. 5783 * 5784 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing 5785 * can be done concurrently. 5786 */ 5787 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5788 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); 5789 5790 /** 5791 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key 5792 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5793 * 5794 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the 5795 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but 5796 * instead assumed to have been removed already. 5797 * 5798 * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently) 5799 * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().) 5800 */ 5801 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5802 5803 /** 5804 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN 5805 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on 5806 * @keyconf: new key data 5807 * 5808 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new 5809 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper 5810 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them. 5811 * 5812 * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will 5813 * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to 5814 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an 5815 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc. 5816 * 5817 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware 5818 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK 5819 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver 5820 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses 5821 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part 5822 * of the reconfiguration. 5823 * 5824 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq() 5825 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly. 5826 * 5827 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware, 5828 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases 5829 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for 5830 * the key that's being replaced. 5831 */ 5832 struct ieee80211_key_conf * 5833 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5834 struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5835 5836 /** 5837 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying 5838 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on 5839 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association 5840 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying 5841 * @gfp: allocation flags 5842 */ 5843 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid, 5844 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp); 5845 5846 /** 5847 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key 5848 * 5849 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called 5850 * at the same time. 5851 * 5852 * @keyconf: the key in question 5853 */ 5854 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5855 5856 /** 5857 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key 5858 * 5859 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called 5860 * at the same time. 5861 * 5862 * @keyconf: the key in question 5863 */ 5864 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5865 5866 /** 5867 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue 5868 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5869 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero). 5870 * 5871 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue. 5872 */ 5873 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue); 5874 5875 /** 5876 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue 5877 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5878 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero). 5879 * 5880 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue. 5881 */ 5882 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue); 5883 5884 /** 5885 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue 5886 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5887 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero). 5888 * 5889 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped. 5890 * 5891 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise. 5892 */ 5893 5894 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue); 5895 5896 /** 5897 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues 5898 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5899 * 5900 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues. 5901 */ 5902 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5903 5904 /** 5905 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues 5906 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5907 * 5908 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues. 5909 */ 5910 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5911 5912 /** 5913 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan 5914 * 5915 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is 5916 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify 5917 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from 5918 * any context, including hardirq context. 5919 * 5920 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan 5921 * @info: information about the completed scan 5922 */ 5923 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5924 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info); 5925 5926 /** 5927 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan 5928 * 5929 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the 5930 * driver whenever there are new scan results available. 5931 * 5932 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans 5933 */ 5934 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5935 5936 /** 5937 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped 5938 * 5939 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by 5940 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task. 5941 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan 5942 * while associating, for instance. 5943 * 5944 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans 5945 */ 5946 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5947 5948 /** 5949 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags 5950 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have 5951 * been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware 5952 * reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new 5953 * interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they 5954 * haven't been re-added to the driver yet. 5955 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all 5956 * interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet. 5957 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up). 5958 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA 5959 * is not in the driver. This may fix crashes during firmware recovery 5960 * for instance. 5961 */ 5962 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags { 5963 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL = 0, 5964 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL = BIT(0), 5965 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE = BIT(1), 5966 IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER = BIT(2), 5967 }; 5968 5969 /** 5970 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces 5971 * 5972 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 5973 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as 5974 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep. 5975 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface(). 5976 * 5977 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 5978 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 5979 * @iterator: the iterator function to call 5980 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 5981 */ 5982 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags, 5983 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac, 5984 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 5985 void *data); 5986 5987 /** 5988 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces 5989 * 5990 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 5991 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them. 5992 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator 5993 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can 5994 * be used. 5995 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface(). 5996 * 5997 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 5998 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 5999 * @iterator: the iterator function to call 6000 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 6001 */ 6002 static inline void 6003 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags, 6004 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac, 6005 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 6006 void *data) 6007 { 6008 ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw, 6009 iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE, 6010 iterator, data); 6011 } 6012 6013 /** 6014 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces 6015 * 6016 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 6017 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them. 6018 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic, 6019 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead. 6020 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface(). 6021 * 6022 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 6023 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 6024 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep 6025 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 6026 */ 6027 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6028 u32 iter_flags, 6029 void (*iterator)(void *data, 6030 u8 *mac, 6031 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 6032 void *data); 6033 6034 /** 6035 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces 6036 * 6037 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 6038 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them. 6039 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex. 6040 * 6041 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 6042 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 6043 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep 6044 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 6045 */ 6046 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6047 u32 iter_flags, 6048 void (*iterator)(void *data, 6049 u8 *mac, 6050 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 6051 void *data); 6052 6053 /** 6054 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations 6055 * 6056 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given 6057 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback 6058 * function for them. 6059 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic, 6060 * 6061 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 6062 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep 6063 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 6064 */ 6065 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6066 void (*iterator)(void *data, 6067 struct ieee80211_sta *sta), 6068 void *data); 6069 /** 6070 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue 6071 * 6072 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue. 6073 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be. 6074 * 6075 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for 6076 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue 6077 */ 6078 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work); 6079 6080 /** 6081 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue 6082 * 6083 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211 6084 * workqueue. 6085 * 6086 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for 6087 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue 6088 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing 6089 */ 6090 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6091 struct delayed_work *dwork, 6092 unsigned long delay); 6093 6094 /** 6095 * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer. 6096 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session 6097 * @tid: the TID to BA on. 6098 * 6099 * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer 6100 * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the 6101 * mac80211. 6102 * 6103 * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section. 6104 */ 6105 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6106 u16 tid); 6107 6108 /** 6109 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session. 6110 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session 6111 * @tid: the TID to BA on. 6112 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs) 6113 * 6114 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise 6115 * 6116 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate 6117 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level 6118 * will be managed by the mac80211. 6119 */ 6120 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid, 6121 u16 timeout); 6122 6123 /** 6124 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate. 6125 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6126 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient. 6127 * @tid: the TID to BA on. 6128 * 6129 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has 6130 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called 6131 * from any context. 6132 */ 6133 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra, 6134 u16 tid); 6135 6136 /** 6137 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session. 6138 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop 6139 * @tid: the TID to stop BA. 6140 * 6141 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active 6142 * 6143 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate 6144 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level 6145 * will be managed by the mac80211. 6146 */ 6147 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid); 6148 6149 /** 6150 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate. 6151 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6152 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient. 6153 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on. 6154 * 6155 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has 6156 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It 6157 * can be called from any context. 6158 */ 6159 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra, 6160 u16 tid); 6161 6162 /** 6163 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station 6164 * 6165 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on 6166 * @addr: station's address 6167 * 6168 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise. 6169 * 6170 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the 6171 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well. 6172 */ 6173 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6174 const u8 *addr); 6175 6176 /** 6177 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware 6178 * 6179 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6180 * @addr: remote station's address 6181 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'. 6182 * 6183 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise. 6184 * 6185 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the 6186 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well. 6187 * 6188 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get 6189 * the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'. 6190 * We can have multiple STA associated with multiple 6191 * logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another 6192 * BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first). 6193 * In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL 6194 * is not reliable. 6195 * 6196 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible. 6197 */ 6198 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6199 const u8 *addr, 6200 const u8 *localaddr); 6201 6202 /** 6203 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses 6204 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6205 * @addr: remote station's link address 6206 * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that) 6207 * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found, 6208 * may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed 6209 * 6210 * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection. 6211 */ 6212 struct ieee80211_sta * 6213 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6214 const u8 *addr, 6215 const u8 *localaddr, 6216 unsigned int *link_id); 6217 6218 /** 6219 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up 6220 * @hw: the hardware 6221 * @pubsta: the station 6222 * @block: whether to block or unblock 6223 * 6224 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues 6225 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before 6226 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be 6227 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected 6228 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag. 6229 * 6230 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free 6231 * manner. 6232 * 6233 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames 6234 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not 6235 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call 6236 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to 6237 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the 6238 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must 6239 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will 6240 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if 6241 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also 6242 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver 6243 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after 6244 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually 6245 * woke up while blocked or not. 6246 */ 6247 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6248 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block); 6249 6250 /** 6251 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP 6252 * @pubsta: the station 6253 * 6254 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell 6255 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the 6256 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead. 6257 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD. 6258 * 6259 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must 6260 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function 6261 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or 6262 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix! 6263 * 6264 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no 6265 * driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if 6266 * you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history 6267 * and restore the _irqsafe version! 6268 */ 6269 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta); 6270 6271 /** 6272 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP 6273 * @pubsta: the station 6274 * @tid: the tid of the NDP 6275 * 6276 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close 6277 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when 6278 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window. 6279 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a 6280 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the 6281 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to 6282 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any 6283 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong. 6284 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame 6285 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save. 6286 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames(). 6287 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver 6288 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call 6289 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent. 6290 */ 6291 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid); 6292 6293 /** 6294 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change 6295 * @pubsta: the station 6296 * 6297 * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in 6298 * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of 6299 * &struct ieee80211_link_sta. 6300 * 6301 * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case 6302 * there is no need to call this function. 6303 */ 6304 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta); 6305 6306 /** 6307 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid 6308 * 6309 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call 6310 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of 6311 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule 6312 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness. 6313 * 6314 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent 6315 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not 6316 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the 6317 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame 6318 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission 6319 * attempts. 6320 * 6321 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or 6322 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available. 6323 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of 6324 * them to 0. 6325 * 6326 * @pubsta: the station 6327 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for 6328 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec) 6329 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec) 6330 */ 6331 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid, 6332 u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime); 6333 6334 /** 6335 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device 6336 * 6337 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6338 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 6339 * 6340 * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can 6341 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false. 6342 */ 6343 bool 6344 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 6345 6346 /** 6347 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device 6348 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6349 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all 6350 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key 6351 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function 6352 * 6353 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to 6354 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into 6355 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device 6356 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due 6357 * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few 6358 * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep. 6359 * 6360 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order 6361 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the 6362 * set_key callback. 6363 */ 6364 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6365 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6366 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6367 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6368 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6369 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key, 6370 void *data), 6371 void *iter_data); 6372 6373 /** 6374 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device 6375 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6376 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all 6377 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key 6378 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function 6379 * 6380 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to 6381 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into 6382 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station 6383 * in removal process will be skipped. 6384 * 6385 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section, 6386 * and thus iter must be atomic. 6387 */ 6388 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6389 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6390 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6391 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6392 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6393 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key, 6394 void *data), 6395 void *iter_data); 6396 6397 /** 6398 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts 6399 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 6400 * @iter: iterator function 6401 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function 6402 * 6403 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and 6404 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other 6405 * places while calling into the driver. 6406 * 6407 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during 6408 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being 6409 * removed. 6410 * 6411 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed 6412 * before the restart are considered already present so will be 6413 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already 6414 * or not. 6415 */ 6416 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic( 6417 struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6418 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6419 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf, 6420 void *data), 6421 void *iter_data); 6422 6423 /** 6424 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template 6425 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 6426 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6427 * 6428 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to 6429 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate 6430 * information. This function must only be called from within the 6431 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function 6432 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return 6433 * %NULL. 6434 * 6435 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error. 6436 */ 6437 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6438 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6439 6440 /** 6441 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons 6442 * 6443 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6444 * 6445 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and 6446 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the 6447 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function. 6448 */ 6449 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6450 6451 /** 6452 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP 6453 * 6454 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6455 * 6456 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and 6457 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver 6458 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost. 6459 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated 6460 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set. 6461 * 6462 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state, 6463 * without connection recovery attempts. 6464 */ 6465 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6466 6467 /** 6468 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection 6469 * 6470 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6471 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired 6472 * 6473 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a 6474 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired. 6475 */ 6476 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect); 6477 6478 /** 6479 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume 6480 * 6481 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6482 * 6483 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume. 6484 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the 6485 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were 6486 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or 6487 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume. 6488 * 6489 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses 6490 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface 6491 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then 6492 * disconnect normally later. 6493 * 6494 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and 6495 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it 6496 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the 6497 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto). 6498 */ 6499 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6500 6501 /** 6502 * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after 6503 * hardware restart 6504 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6505 * 6506 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after 6507 * hardware restart. 6508 */ 6509 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6510 6511 /** 6512 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring 6513 * rssi threshold triggered 6514 * 6515 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6516 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type 6517 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available 6518 * @gfp: context flags 6519 * 6520 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality 6521 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform 6522 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold. 6523 */ 6524 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6525 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event, 6526 s32 rssi_level, 6527 gfp_t gfp); 6528 6529 /** 6530 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss 6531 * 6532 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6533 * @gfp: context flags 6534 */ 6535 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp); 6536 6537 /** 6538 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected 6539 * 6540 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6541 */ 6542 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6543 6544 /** 6545 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process 6546 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6547 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not 6548 * 6549 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel 6550 * and wake up the suspended queues. 6551 */ 6552 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success); 6553 6554 /** 6555 * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error 6556 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6557 * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame. 6558 * 6559 * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel 6560 * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send 6561 * a deauth frame in this case. 6562 */ 6563 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6564 bool block_tx); 6565 6566 /** 6567 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition 6568 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6569 * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0 6570 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode 6571 * 6572 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed 6573 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than 6574 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth. 6575 */ 6576 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id, 6577 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode); 6578 6579 /** 6580 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start 6581 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6582 */ 6583 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6584 6585 /** 6586 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired 6587 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6588 */ 6589 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6590 6591 /** 6592 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions 6593 * 6594 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device 6595 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba 6596 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs 6597 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)." 6598 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and 6599 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation. 6600 * 6601 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6602 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid 6603 * @addr: & to bssid mac address 6604 */ 6605 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap, 6606 const u8 *addr); 6607 6608 /** 6609 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered 6610 * @pubsta: station struct 6611 * @tid: the session's TID 6612 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are 6613 * assumed to be out of the window after the call 6614 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc. 6615 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware 6616 * 6617 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and 6618 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it 6619 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released 6620 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.) 6621 * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames) 6622 */ 6623 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid, 6624 u16 ssn, u64 filtered, 6625 u16 received_mpdus); 6626 6627 /** 6628 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame 6629 * 6630 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder 6631 * buffer. 6632 * 6633 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6634 * @ra: the peer's destination address 6635 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session 6636 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver 6637 */ 6638 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn); 6639 6640 /** 6641 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work 6642 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6643 * @addr: station mac address 6644 * @tid: the rx tid 6645 */ 6646 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr, 6647 unsigned int tid); 6648 6649 /** 6650 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session 6651 * 6652 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including 6653 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx 6654 * reordering. 6655 * 6656 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here 6657 * when they complete AddBa negotiation. 6658 * 6659 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6660 * @addr: station mac address 6661 * @tid: the rx tid 6662 */ 6663 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6664 const u8 *addr, u16 tid) 6665 { 6666 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)) 6667 return; 6668 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid); 6669 } 6670 6671 /** 6672 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session 6673 * 6674 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including 6675 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx 6676 * reordering. 6677 * 6678 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here 6679 * when they complete DelBa negotiation. 6680 * 6681 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6682 * @addr: station mac address 6683 * @tid: the rx tid 6684 */ 6685 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6686 const u8 *addr, u16 tid) 6687 { 6688 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)) 6689 return; 6690 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS); 6691 } 6692 6693 /** 6694 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout 6695 * 6696 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx 6697 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer. 6698 * 6699 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa. 6700 * 6701 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6702 * @addr: station mac address 6703 * @tid: the rx tid 6704 */ 6705 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6706 const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid); 6707 6708 /* Rate control API */ 6709 6710 /** 6711 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo 6712 * 6713 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for. 6714 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on. 6715 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration 6716 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs 6717 * to be filled in 6718 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate 6719 * which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and 6720 * used for rate calculations in the mesh network. 6721 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the 6722 * RTS threshold 6723 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission 6724 * if the selected rate supports it 6725 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask 6726 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use) 6727 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode 6728 */ 6729 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control { 6730 struct ieee80211_hw *hw; 6731 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband; 6732 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf; 6733 struct sk_buff *skb; 6734 struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate; 6735 bool rts, short_preamble; 6736 u32 rate_idx_mask; 6737 u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask; 6738 bool bss; 6739 }; 6740 6741 /** 6742 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities 6743 */ 6744 enum rate_control_capabilities { 6745 /** 6746 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: 6747 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable) 6748 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains 6749 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has, 6750 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us. 6751 */ 6752 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0), 6753 /** 6754 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER: 6755 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx 6756 */ 6757 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1), 6758 }; 6759 6760 struct rate_control_ops { 6761 unsigned long capa; 6762 const char *name; 6763 void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6764 void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv, 6765 struct dentry *debugfsdir); 6766 void (*free)(void *priv); 6767 6768 void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp); 6769 void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6770 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 6771 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta); 6772 void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6773 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 6774 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta, 6775 u32 changed); 6776 void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6777 void *priv_sta); 6778 6779 void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv, 6780 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6781 void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st); 6782 void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6783 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta, 6784 struct sk_buff *skb); 6785 void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta, 6786 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc); 6787 6788 void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta, 6789 struct dentry *dir); 6790 6791 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta); 6792 }; 6793 6794 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6795 enum nl80211_band band, 6796 int index) 6797 { 6798 return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index)); 6799 } 6800 6801 static inline s8 6802 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6803 struct ieee80211_sta *sta) 6804 { 6805 int i; 6806 6807 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++) 6808 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i)) 6809 return i; 6810 6811 /* warn when we cannot find a rate. */ 6812 WARN_ON_ONCE(1); 6813 6814 /* and return 0 (the lowest index) */ 6815 return 0; 6816 } 6817 6818 static inline 6819 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6820 struct ieee80211_sta *sta) 6821 { 6822 unsigned int i; 6823 6824 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++) 6825 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i)) 6826 return true; 6827 return false; 6828 } 6829 6830 /** 6831 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver 6832 * 6833 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass 6834 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station 6835 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on 6836 * the most recent rate control module decision. 6837 * 6838 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6839 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination. 6840 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station. 6841 */ 6842 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6843 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, 6844 struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates); 6845 6846 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops); 6847 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops); 6848 6849 static inline bool 6850 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6851 { 6852 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20; 6853 } 6854 6855 static inline bool 6856 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6857 { 6858 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 && 6859 conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq; 6860 } 6861 6862 static inline bool 6863 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6864 { 6865 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 && 6866 conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq; 6867 } 6868 6869 static inline bool 6870 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6871 { 6872 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40; 6873 } 6874 6875 static inline bool 6876 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6877 { 6878 return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) && 6879 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) && 6880 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT); 6881 } 6882 6883 static inline enum nl80211_iftype 6884 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p) 6885 { 6886 if (p2p) { 6887 switch (type) { 6888 case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: 6889 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT; 6890 case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: 6891 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO; 6892 default: 6893 break; 6894 } 6895 } 6896 return type; 6897 } 6898 6899 static inline enum nl80211_iftype 6900 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 6901 { 6902 return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p); 6903 } 6904 6905 /** 6906 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif 6907 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 6908 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from 6909 * 6910 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found 6911 */ 6912 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap * 6913 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6914 struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 6915 { 6916 return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif)); 6917 } 6918 6919 /** 6920 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities 6921 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 6922 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from 6923 * 6924 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities 6925 */ 6926 static inline __le16 6927 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6928 struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 6929 { 6930 return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif)); 6931 } 6932 6933 /** 6934 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif 6935 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 6936 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from 6937 * 6938 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found 6939 */ 6940 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap * 6941 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6942 struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 6943 { 6944 return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif)); 6945 } 6946 6947 /** 6948 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data 6949 * 6950 * @vif: the specified virtual interface 6951 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0 6952 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group 6953 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group 6954 * 6955 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and 6956 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the 6957 * matching GroupId management frame. 6958 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path. 6959 */ 6960 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id, 6961 const u8 *membership, const u8 *position); 6962 6963 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6964 int rssi_min_thold, 6965 int rssi_max_thold); 6966 6967 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6968 6969 /** 6970 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface 6971 * 6972 * @vif: the specified virtual interface 6973 * 6974 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid. 6975 * 6976 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not 6977 * applicable. 6978 */ 6979 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6980 6981 /** 6982 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup 6983 * @vif: virtual interface 6984 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s) 6985 * @gfp: allocation flags 6986 * 6987 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(). 6988 */ 6989 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6990 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup, 6991 gfp_t gfp); 6992 6993 /** 6994 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission 6995 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6996 * @vif: virtual interface 6997 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver 6998 * @band: the band to transmit on 6999 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to 7000 * 7001 * Note: must be called under RCU lock 7002 */ 7003 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7004 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb, 7005 int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta); 7006 7007 /** 7008 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header 7009 * of injected frames. 7010 * 7011 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields, 7012 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure 7013 * of the skb before calling this function. 7014 * 7015 * @skb: packet injected by userspace 7016 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device 7017 */ 7018 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb, 7019 struct net_device *dev); 7020 7021 /** 7022 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state 7023 * 7024 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change 7025 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending 7026 * 7027 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent 7028 * 7029 * private: 7030 * 7031 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors 7032 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA 7033 */ 7034 struct ieee80211_noa_data { 7035 u32 next_tsf; 7036 bool has_next_tsf; 7037 7038 u8 absent; 7039 7040 u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX]; 7041 struct { 7042 u32 start; 7043 u32 duration; 7044 u32 interval; 7045 } desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX]; 7046 }; 7047 7048 /** 7049 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE 7050 * 7051 * @attr: P2P NoA IE 7052 * @data: NoA tracking data 7053 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp 7054 * 7055 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors 7056 */ 7057 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr, 7058 struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf); 7059 7060 /** 7061 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change 7062 * 7063 * @data: NoA tracking data 7064 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp 7065 */ 7066 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf); 7067 7068 /** 7069 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation 7070 * @vif: virtual interface 7071 * @peer: the peer's destination address 7072 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation 7073 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown 7074 * @gfp: allocation flags 7075 * 7076 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(). 7077 */ 7078 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer, 7079 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper, 7080 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp); 7081 7082 /** 7083 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID 7084 * 7085 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from 7086 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such 7087 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID, 7088 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks 7089 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be 7090 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC. 7091 * 7092 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it 7093 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should 7094 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback. 7095 * 7096 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for 7097 * @tid: the TID to reserve 7098 * 7099 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure 7100 */ 7101 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid); 7102 7103 /** 7104 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID 7105 * 7106 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function 7107 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for 7108 * preventing use of this TID in the driver. 7109 * 7110 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called 7111 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called 7112 * from the driver's @sta_state callback. 7113 * 7114 * @sta: the station 7115 * @tid: the TID to unreserve 7116 */ 7117 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid); 7118 7119 /** 7120 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue 7121 * 7122 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7123 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from 7124 * ieee80211_next_txq() 7125 * 7126 * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available. 7127 * 7128 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section, 7129 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in 7130 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the 7131 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call 7132 * but for the duration of the frame handling. 7133 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method, 7134 * rcu_read_lock() is already held. 7135 * 7136 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called. 7137 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead. 7138 */ 7139 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7140 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 7141 7142 /** 7143 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue 7144 * (in process context) 7145 * 7146 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context 7147 * (internally disables bottom halves). 7148 * 7149 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7150 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from 7151 * ieee80211_next_txq() 7152 */ 7153 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7154 struct ieee80211_txq *txq) 7155 { 7156 struct sk_buff *skb; 7157 7158 local_bh_disable(); 7159 skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq); 7160 local_bh_enable(); 7161 7162 return skb; 7163 } 7164 7165 /** 7166 * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback 7167 * 7168 * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback(). 7169 * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback(). 7170 * 7171 * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue 7172 * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function. 7173 */ 7174 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7175 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 7176 7177 /** 7178 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from 7179 * 7180 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7181 * @ac: AC number to return packets from. 7182 * 7183 * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq 7184 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the 7185 * driver has finished scheduling it. 7186 */ 7187 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac); 7188 7189 /** 7190 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs 7191 * 7192 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7193 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for 7194 * 7195 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq(). 7196 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently. 7197 */ 7198 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac); 7199 7200 /* (deprecated) */ 7201 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac) 7202 { 7203 } 7204 7205 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7206 struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force); 7207 7208 /** 7209 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission 7210 * 7211 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7212 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7213 * 7214 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled, 7215 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered. 7216 * 7217 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for 7218 * this TXQ internally. 7219 */ 7220 static inline void 7221 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq) 7222 { 7223 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true); 7224 } 7225 7226 /** 7227 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq() 7228 * 7229 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7230 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7231 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets. 7232 * 7233 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ 7234 * internally. 7235 */ 7236 static inline void 7237 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq, 7238 bool force) 7239 { 7240 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force); 7241 } 7242 7243 /** 7244 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit 7245 * 7246 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by 7247 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime 7248 * fairness accounting without going using the scheduling order enfored by 7249 * next_txq(). 7250 * 7251 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to 7252 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have 7253 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will 7254 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit 7255 * again. 7256 * 7257 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be 7258 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates 7259 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry 7260 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this 7261 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets 7262 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq(). 7263 * 7264 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7265 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7266 */ 7267 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7268 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 7269 7270 /** 7271 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq 7272 * 7273 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e. 7274 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up 7275 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa. 7276 * 7277 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7278 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count 7279 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count 7280 */ 7281 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq, 7282 unsigned long *frame_cnt, 7283 unsigned long *byte_cnt); 7284 7285 /** 7286 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination. 7287 * 7288 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination. 7289 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq. 7290 * 7291 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7292 * @inst_id: the local instance id 7293 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*) 7294 * @gfp: allocation flags 7295 */ 7296 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7297 u8 inst_id, 7298 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason, 7299 gfp_t gfp); 7300 7301 /** 7302 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event. 7303 * 7304 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The 7305 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211. 7306 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq. 7307 * 7308 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7309 * @match: match event information 7310 * @gfp: allocation flags 7311 */ 7312 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7313 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, 7314 gfp_t gfp); 7315 7316 /** 7317 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX. 7318 * 7319 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the 7320 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length. 7321 * 7322 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7323 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate 7324 * information. 7325 * @len: frame length in bytes 7326 */ 7327 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7328 struct ieee80211_rx_status *status, 7329 int len); 7330 7331 /** 7332 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX. 7333 * 7334 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the 7335 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length. 7336 * 7337 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7338 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 7339 * @len: frame length in bytes 7340 */ 7341 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7342 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, 7343 int len); 7344 /** 7345 * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading. 7346 * 7347 * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3 7348 * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the 7349 * hardware or firmware. 7350 * 7351 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7352 * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off 7353 */ 7354 bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable); 7355 7356 /** 7357 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template. 7358 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 7359 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7360 * 7361 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 7362 * 7363 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error. 7364 */ 7365 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7366 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 7367 7368 /** 7369 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast 7370 * probe response template. 7371 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 7372 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7373 * 7374 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 7375 * 7376 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error. 7377 */ 7378 struct sk_buff * 7379 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7380 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 7381 7382 /** 7383 * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color 7384 * collision. 7385 * 7386 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7387 * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is 7388 * aware of. 7389 * @gfp: allocation flags 7390 */ 7391 void 7392 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7393 u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp); 7394 7395 /** 7396 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame 7397 * 7398 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with 7399 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames. 7400 * 7401 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted. 7402 */ 7403 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb) 7404 { 7405 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb); 7406 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data; 7407 7408 return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP || 7409 ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control); 7410 } 7411 7412 /** 7413 * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode 7414 * @vif: interface to set active links on 7415 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap 7416 * 7417 * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface 7418 * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active), 7419 * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links. 7420 * 7421 * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same 7422 * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get 7423 * a sequence of calls like 7424 * - change_vif_links(0x11) 7425 * - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0) 7426 * - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP) 7427 * (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down) 7428 * - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0) 7429 * - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4) 7430 * - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP) 7431 * - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4) 7432 * - change_vif_links(0x10) 7433 * 7434 * Note: This function acquires some mac80211 locks and must not 7435 * be called with any driver locks held that could cause a 7436 * lock dependency inversion. Best call it without locks. 7437 */ 7438 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links); 7439 7440 /** 7441 * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links 7442 * @vif: interface to set active links on 7443 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap 7444 * 7445 * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only 7446 * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and 7447 * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be 7448 * completed after it returns. 7449 */ 7450 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7451 u16 active_links); 7452 7453 #endif /* MAC80211_H */ 7454